annotate man/viper.texi @ 26541:ce6bf7b42bc7

--with-syntax-table changed.
author Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
date Mon, 22 Nov 1999 15:14:45 +0000
parents 2b08d829af86
children 6fb7a3864791
Ignore whitespace changes - Everywhere: Within whitespace: At end of lines:
rev   line source
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1 % -*-texinfo-*-
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2 \input texinfo
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4 @comment Using viper.info instead of viper in setfilename breaks DOS.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5 @comment @setfilename viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6 @comment @setfilename viper.info
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7 @setfilename ../info/viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
8
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
9 @dircategory Editors
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
10 @direntry
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
11 * VIPER: (viper). The newest Emacs VI-emulation mode.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
12 (also, A VI Plan for Emacs Rescue
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
13 or the VI PERil.)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
14 @end direntry
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
15
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
16 @iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
17 @finalout
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
18 @end iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
19
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
20 @titlepage
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
21 @title Viper Is a Package for Emacs Rebels
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
22 @subtitle a Vi emulator for Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
23 @subtitle March 1998, Viper Version 3.02 (Polyglot)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
24
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
25 @author Michael Kifer (Viper)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
26 @author Aamod Sane (VIP 4.4)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
27 @author Masahiko Sato (VIP 3.5)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
28
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
29 @page
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
30 @vskip 0pt plus 1fill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
31 @end titlepage
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
32
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
33 @unnumbered Distribution
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
34
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
35 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
36 Copyright @copyright{} 1995, 1996, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
37
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
38 Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
39 this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
40 are preserved on all copies.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
41
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
42 @ignore
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
43 Permission is granted to process this file through TeX and print the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
44 results, provided the printed document carries copying permission
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
45 notice identical to this one except for the removal of this paragraph
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
46 (this paragraph not being relevant to the printed manual).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
47
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
48 @end ignore
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
49 Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
50 manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided that the entire
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
51 resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a permission
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
52 notice identical to this one.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
53
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
54 Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
55 into another language, under the same conditions as for modified versions.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
56
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
57 @ifinfo
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
58 @node Top, Overview,, (DIR)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
59
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
60 @unnumbered Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
61
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
62 We believe that one or more of the following statements are adequate
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
63 descriptions:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
64
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
65 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
66 Viper Is a Package for Emacs Rebels;
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
67 it is a VI Plan for Emacs Rescue
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
68 and/or a venomous VI PERil.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
69 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
70
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
71 Technically speaking, Viper is a Vi emulation package for Emacs. It
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
72 implements all Vi and Ex commands, occasionally improving on them and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
73 adding many new features. It gives the user the best of both worlds: Vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
74 keystrokes for editing combined with the power of the Emacs environment.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
75
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
76 Viper emulates Vi at several levels, from the one that closely follows Vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
77 conventions to the one that departs from many of them. It has many
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
78 customizable options, which can be used to tailor Viper to the work habits
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
79 of various users.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
80 This manual describes Viper, concentrating on the differences from Vi and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
81 new features of Viper.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
82
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
83 Viper, formerly known as VIP-19, was written by Michael Kifer. It is based
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
84 on VIP version 3.5 by Masahiko Sato and VIP version 4.4 by Aamod Sane.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
85 Viper tries to be compatible with these packages.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
86
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
87 Viper is intended to be usable without reading this manual --- the defaults
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
88 are set to make Viper as close to Vi as possible. At startup, Viper will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
89 try to set the most appropriate default environment for you, based on
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
90 your familiarity with Emacs. It will also tell you the basic GNU Emacs window
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
91 management commands to help you start immediately.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
92
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
93 Although this manual explains how to customize Viper, some basic
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
94 familiarity with Emacs Lisp would be a plus.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
95
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
96 It is recommended that you read the Overview node. The other nodes may
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
97 be visited as needed.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
98
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
99 Comments and bug reports are welcome.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
100 @code{kifer@@cs.emacs.edu} is the current address for Viper bug reports.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
101 Please use the Ex command @kbd{:submitReport} for this purpose.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
102
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
103 @end ifinfo
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
104
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
105 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
106 * Overview:: Must read to get started
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
107 * Improvements over Vi:: New features, Improvements
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
108 * Customization:: How to customize Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
109 * Commands:: Vi and Ex Commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
110
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
111 * Key Index:: Index of Vi and Ex Commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
112 * Function Index:: Index of Viper Functions
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
113 * Variable Index:: Index of Viper Variables
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
114 * Package Index:: Index of Packages Mentioned in this Document
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
115 * Concept Index:: Vi, Ex and Emacs concepts
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
116
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
117 * Acknowledgments::
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
118 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
119 @iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
120 @unnumbered Introduction
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
121
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
122 We believe that one or more of the following statements are adequate
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
123 descriptions:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
124
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
125 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
126 Viper Is a Package for Emacs Rebels;
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
127 it is a VI Plan for Emacs Rescue
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
128 and/or a venomous VI PERil.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
129 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
130
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
131 Viper is a Vi emulation package for Emacs. Viper contains virtually all
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
132 of Vi and Ex functionality and much more. It gives you the best of both
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
133 worlds: Vi keystrokes for editing combined with the GNU Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
134 environment. Viper also fixes some common complaints with Vi commands.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
135 This manual describes Viper, concentrating on the differences from Vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
136 and on the new features of Viper.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
137
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
138 Viper was written by Michael Kifer. It is based on VIP version 3.5 by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
139 Masahiko Sato and VIP version 4.4 by Aamod Sane. Viper tries to be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
140 compatible with these packages.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
141
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
142 Viper is intended to be usable out of the box, without reading this manual
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
143 --- the defaults are set to make Viper as close to Vi as possible. At
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
144 startup, Viper will attempt to set the most appropriate default environment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
145 for you, based on your familiarity with Emacs. It will also tell you the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
146 basic GNU Emacs window management commands to help you start immediately.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
147
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
148 Although this manual explains how to customize Viper, some basic
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
149 familiarity with Emacs Lisp would be a plus.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
150
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
151 It is recommended that you read the chapter Overview. The other chapters
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
152 will be useful for customization and advanced usage.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
153
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
154 You should also learn to use the Info on-line hypertext manual system that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
155 comes with Emacs. This manual can be read as an Info file. Try the command
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
156 @kbd{@key{ESC} x info} with vanilla Emacs sometime.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
157
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
158 Comments and bug reports are welcome.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
159 @code{kifer@@cs.sunysb.edu} is the current address for Viper bug reports.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
160 Please use the Ex command @kbd{:submitReport} for this purpose.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
161
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
162 @end iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
163
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
164 @node Overview,Improvements over Vi,Top,Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
165 @chapter Overview of Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
166
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
167 Viper is a Vi emulation on top of Emacs. At the same time, Viper provides a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
168 virtually unrestricted access to Emacs facilities. Perfect compatibility
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
169 with Vi is possible but not desirable. This chapter tells you about the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
170 Emacs ideas that you should know about, how to use Viper within Emacs and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
171 some incompatibilities.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
172
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
173 Viper was formerly known as VIP-19, which was
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
174 a descendant of VIP 3.5 by Masahiko Sato and VIP 4.4 by Aamod Sane.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
175
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
176 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
177 * Emacs Preliminaries:: Basic concepts in Emacs.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
178 * Loading Viper:: Loading and Preliminary Configuration.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
179 * States in Viper:: Viper has four states orthogonal to Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
180 modes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
181 * The Minibuffer:: Command line in Emacs.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
182 * Multiple Files in Viper:: True multiple file handling.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
183 * Unimplemented Features:: That are unlikely to be implemented.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
184 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
185
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
186 @node Emacs Preliminaries, Loading Viper, Overview, Overview
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
187 @section Emacs Preliminaries
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
188
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
189 @cindex buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
190 @cindex point
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
191 @cindex mark
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
192 @cindex text
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
193 @cindex looking at
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
194 @cindex end (of buffer)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
195 @cindex end (of line)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
196 @cindex region
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
197
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
198 Emacs can edit several files at once. A file in Emacs is placed in a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
199 @dfn{buffer} that usually has the same name as the file. Buffers are also used
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
200 for other purposes, such as shell interfaces, directory editing, etc.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
201 @xref{Dired,,Directory Editor,emacs,The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
202 Gnu Emacs Manual}, for an example.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
203
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
204 A buffer has a distinguished position called the @dfn{point}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
205 A @dfn{point} is always between 2 characters, and is @dfn{looking at}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
206 the right hand character. The cursor is positioned on the right hand
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
207 character. Thus, when the @dfn{point} is looking at the end-of-line,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
208 the cursor is on the end-of-line character, i.e.@: beyond the last
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
209 character on the line. This is the default Emacs behavior.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
210
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
211 The default settings of Viper try to mimic the behavior of Vi, preventing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
212 the cursor from going beyond the last character on the line. By using
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
213 Emacs commands directly (such as those bound to arrow keys), it is possible
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
214 to get the cursor beyond the end-of-line. However, this won't (or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
215 shouldn't) happen if you restrict yourself to standard Vi keys, unless you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
216 modify the default editing style. @xref{Customization}.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
217
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
218 In addition to the @dfn{point}, there is another distinguished buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
219 position called the @dfn{mark}. @xref{Mark,,Mark,emacs,The GNU Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
220 manual}, for more info on the mark. The text between the @dfn{point} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
221 the @dfn{mark} is called the @dfn{region} of the buffer. For the Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
222 user, this simply means that in addition to the Vi textmarkers a--z, there
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
223 is another marker called @dfn{mark}. This is similar to the unnamed Vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
224 marker used by the jump commands @kbd{``} and @kbd{''}, which move the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
225 cursor to the position of the last absolute jump. Viper provides access to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
226 the region in most text manipulation commands as @kbd{r} and @kbd{R} suffix
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
227 to commands that operate on text regions, e.g., @kbd{dr} to delete region,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
228 etc.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
229
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
230 Furthermore, Viper lets Ex-style commands to work on the current region.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
231 This is done by typing a digit argument before @kbd{:}. For instance,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
232 typing @kbd{1:} will propmt you with something like @emph{:123,135},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
233 assuming that the current region starts at line 123 and ends at line
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
234 135. There is no need to type the line numbers, since Viper inserts them
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
235 automatically in front of the Ex command.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
236
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
237 @xref{Basics}, for more info.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
238
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
239 @cindex window
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
240 @cindex mode line
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
241 @cindex buffer information
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
242 @cindex Minibuffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
243 @cindex command line
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
244 @cindex buffer (modified)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
245
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
246 Emacs divides the screen into tiled @dfn{windows}. You can see the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
247 contents of a buffer through the window associated with the buffer. The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
248 cursor of the screen is positioned on the character after @dfn{point}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
249 Every window has a @dfn{mode line} that displays information about the buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
250 You can change the format of the mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
251 line, but normally if you see @samp{**} at the beginning of a mode line it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
252 means that the buffer is @dfn{modified}. If you write out the contents of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
253 a buffer to a file, then the buffer will become not modified. Also if
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
254 you see @samp{%%} at the beginning of the mode line, it means that the file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
255 associated with the buffer is write protected. The mode line will also
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
256 show the buffer name and current major and minor modes (see below).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
257 A special buffer called @dfn{Minibuffer} is displayed as the last line
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
258 in a Minibuffer window. The Minibuffer window is used for command input
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
259 output. Viper uses Minibuffer window for @kbd{/} and @kbd{:}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
260 commands.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
261
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
262 @cindex mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
263 @cindex keymap
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
264 @cindex local keymap
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
265 @cindex global keymap
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
266 @cindex major mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
267 @cindex minor mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
268
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
269 An Emacs buffer can have a @dfn{major mode} that customizes Emacs for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
270 editing text of a particular sort by changing the functionality of the keys.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
271 Keys are defined using a @dfn{keymap} that records the bindings between
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
272 keystrokes and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
273 functions. The @dfn{global keymap} is common to all the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
274 buffers. Additionally, each buffer has its @dfn{local keymap} that determines the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
275 @dfn{mode} of the buffer. If a function is bound to some key in the local
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
276 keymap then that function will be executed when you type the key.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
277 If no function is bound to a key in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
278 local map, however, the function bound to the key in the global map
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
279 will be executed. @xref{Major Modes,Major Modes,Major Modes,emacs,The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
280 GNU Emacs Manual}, for more information.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
281
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
282 A buffer can also have a @dfn{minor mode}. Minor modes are options that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
283 you can use or not. A buffer in @code{text-mode} can have
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
284 @code{auto-fill-mode} as minor mode, which can be turned off or on at
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
285 any time. In Emacs, a minor mode may have it own keymap,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
286 which overrides the local keymap when the minor mode is turned on. For
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
287 more information, @pxref{Minor Modes,Minor Modes,Minor Modes,emacs,The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
288 GNU Emacs Manual} @refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
289
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
290 @cindex Viper as minor mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
291 @cindex Control keys
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
292 @cindex Meta key
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
293
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
294 Viper is implemented as a collection of minor modes. Different minor modes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
295 are involved when Viper emulates Vi command mode, Vi insert mode, etc.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
296 You can also turn Viper on and off at any time while in Vi command mode.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
297 @xref{States in Viper}, for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
298 more information.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
299
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
300 Emacs uses Control and Meta modifiers. These are denoted as C and M,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
301 e.g.@: @kbd{^Z} as @kbd{C-z} and @kbd{Meta-x} as @kbd{M-x}. The Meta key is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
302 usually located on each side of the Space bar; it is used in a manner
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
303 similar to the Control key, e.g., @kbd{M-x} means typing @kbd{x} while
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
304 holding the Meta key down. For keyboards that do not have a Meta key,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
305 @key{ESC} is used as Meta. Thus @kbd{M-x} is typed as @kbd{@key{ESC}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
306 x}. Viper uses @key{ESC} to switch from Insert state to Vi state. Therefore
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
307 Viper defines @kbd{C-\} as its Meta key in Vi state. @xref{Vi State}, for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
308 more info.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
309
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
310 Emacs is structured as a lisp interpreter around a C core. Emacs keys
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
311 cause lisp functions to be called. It is possible to call these
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
312 functions directly, by typing @kbd{M-x function-name}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
313
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
314 @node Loading Viper, States in Viper, Emacs Preliminaries, Overview
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
315 @section Loading Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
316
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
317 The most common way to load it automatically is to include the following
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
318 lines (in the given order!):
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
319
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
320 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
321 (setq viper-mode t)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
322 (require 'viper)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
323 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
324
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
325 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
326 in your @file{~/.emacs} file. The @file{.emacs} file is placed in your
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
327 home directory and it is be executed every time you invoke Emacs. This is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
328 the place where all general Emacs customization takes place. Beginning with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
329 version 20.0, Emacsen have an interactive interface, which simplifies the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
330 job of customization significantly.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
331
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
332 Viper also uses the file @file{~/.viper} for Viper-specific customization.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
333 If you wish to be in Vi command state whenever this is deemed appropriate
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
334 by the author, you can include the following line in your @file{.viper}:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
335 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
336 (setq viper-always t)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
337 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
338 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
339 (@xref{Vi State}, for the explanation of Vi command state.)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
340
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
341 The location of Viper customization file can be changed by setting the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
342 variable @code{viper-custom-file-name} in @file{.emacs} @emph{prior} to loading
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
343 Viper.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
344
26263
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
345 The latest versions of Emacs have an interactive customization facility,
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
346 which allows you to (mostly) bypass the use of the @file{.emacs} and
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
347 @file{.viper} files. You can reach this customization
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
348 facility from within Viper's VI state by executing the Ex command
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
349 @kbd{:customize}.
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
350
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
351 Once invoked, Viper will arrange to bring up Emacs buffers in Vi state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
352 whenever this makes sense.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
353 @xref{Packages that Change Keymaps}, to find out when forcing Vi command state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
354 on a buffer may be counter-productive.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
355
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
356 Even if your @file{.emacs} and @file{.viper} files do not contain any of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
357 above lines, you can still load Viper and enter Vi command state by typing the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
358 following from within Emacs:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
359
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
360 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
361 M-x viper-mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
362 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
363
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
364 When Emacs first comes up, if you have not specified a file on the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
365 command line, it will show the @samp{*scratch*} buffer, in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
366 @samp{Lisp Interaction} mode. After you invoke Viper, you can start
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
367 editing files by using @kbd{:e}, @kbd{:vi}, or @kbd{v} commands.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
368 (@xref{File and Buffer Handling}, for more information on @kbd{v} and other
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
369 new commands that, in many cases, are more convenient than @kbd{:e},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
370 @kbd{:vi}, and similar old-style Vi commands.)@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
371
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
372 Finally, if at some point you would want to get de-Viperize your running
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
373 copy of Emacs after Viper has been loaded, the command @kbd{M-x
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
374 viper-go-away} will do it for you. The function @code{toggle-viper-mode}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
375 toggles Viperization of Emacs on and off.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
376
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
377 @node States in Viper, The Minibuffer, Loading Viper,Overview
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
378 @section States in Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
379
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
380 @kindex @kbd{C-z}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
381 @kindex @key{ESC}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
382 @kindex @kbd{i}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
383 @cindex Emacs state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
384 @cindex Vi state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
385 @cindex Insert state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
386 @cindex Replace state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
387 @cindex Ex commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
388 @findex @code{viper-go-away}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
389 @findex @code{toggle-viper-mode}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
390
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
391 Viper has four states, Emacs, Vi, Insert, and Replace.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
392
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
393 @table @samp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
394 @item Emacs state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
395 This is the state plain vanilla Emacs is normally in. After you have loaded
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
396 Viper, @kbd{C-z} will normally take you to Vi command state. Another
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
397 @kbd{C-z} will take you back to Emacs state. This toggle key can be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
398 changed, @pxref{Customization} You can also type @kbd{M-x viper-mode} to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
399 change to Vi state.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
400
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
401
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
402 For users who chose to set their user level to 1 at Viper setup time,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
403 switching to Emacs state is deliberately made harder in order to not
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
404 confuse the novice user. In this case, @kbd{C-z} will either iconify Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
405 (if Emacs runs as an application under X Windows) or it will stop Emacs (if
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
406 Emacs runs on a dumb terminal or in an Xterm window).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
407
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
408 @item Vi state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
409 This is the Vi command mode. Any of the Vi commands, such as @kbd{i, o, a},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
410 @dots{}, will take you to Insert state. All Vi commands may
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
411 be used in this mode. Most Ex commands can also be used.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
412 For a full list of Ex commands supported by Viper, type
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
413 @kbd{:} and then @key{TAB}. To get help on any issue, including the Ex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
414 commands, type @kbd{:help}. This will invoke Viper Info
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
415 (if it is installed). Then typing @kbd{i} will prompt you for a topic to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
416 search in the index. Note: to search for Ex commands in the index, you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
417 should start them with a ``@kbd{:}'', e.g., @kbd{:WW}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
418
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
419 In Viper, Ex commands can be made to work on the current Emacs region.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
420 This is done by typing a digit argument before @kbd{:}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
421 For instance, typing @kbd{1:} will propmt you with something like
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
422 @emph{:123,135}, assuming that the current region starts at line 123 and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
423 ends at line 135. There is no need to type the line numbers, since Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
424 inserts them automatically in front of the Ex command.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
425
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
426 @item Insert state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
427 Insert state is the Vi insertion mode. @key{ESC} will take you back to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
428 Vi state. Insert state editing can be done, including auto-indentation. By
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
429 default, Viper disables Emacs keybindings in Insert state.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
430
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
431 @item Replace state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
432 Commands like @kbd{cw} invoke the Replace state. When you cross the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
433 boundary of a replacement region (usually designated via a @samp{$} sign),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
434 it will automatically change to Insert state. You do not have to worry
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
435 about it. The key bindings remain practically the same as in Insert
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
436 state. If you type @key{ESC}, Viper will switch to Vi command mode, terminating the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
437 replacement state.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
438 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
439
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
440 @cindex mode line
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
441
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
442 The modes are indicated on the @dfn{mode line} as <E>, <I>, <V>, and <R>,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
443 so that the multiple modes do not confuse you. Most of your editing can be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
444 done in Vi and Insert states. Viper will try to make all new buffers be in Vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
445 state, but sometimes they may come up in Emacs state. @kbd{C-z}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
446 will take you to Vi state in such a case. In some major modes, like Dired,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
447 Info, Gnus, etc., you should not switch to Vi state (and Viper will not
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
448 attempt to do so) because these modes are not intended for text editing and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
449 many of the Vi keys have special meaning there. If you plan to read news,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
450 browse directories, read mail, etc., from Emacs (which you should start
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
451 doing soon!), you should learn about the meaning of the various keys in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
452 those special modes (typing @kbd{C-h m} in a buffer provides
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
453 help with key bindings for the major mode of that buffer).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
454
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
455 If you switch to Vi in Dired or similar modes---no harm is done. It is just
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
456 that the special keybindings provided by those modes will be temporarily
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
457 overshadowed by Viper's bindings. Switching back to Viper's Emacs state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
458 will revive the environment provided by the current major mode.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
459
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
460 States in Viper are orthogonal to Emacs major modes, such as C mode or Dired
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
461 mode. You can turn Viper on and off for any Emacs state. When Viper is turned
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
462 on, Vi state can be used to move around. In Insert state, the bindings for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
463 these modes can be accessed. For beginners (users at Viper levels 1 and 2),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
464 these bindings are suppressed in Insert state, so that new users are not
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
465 confused by the Emacs states. Note that unless you allow Emacs bindings in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
466 Insert state, you cannot do many interesting things, like language
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
467 sensitive editing. For the novice user (at Viper level 1), all major mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
468 bindings are turned off in Vi state as well. This includes the bindings for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
469 key sequences that start with @kbd{C-c}, which practically means that all
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
470 major mode bindings are supported. @xref{Customization}, to find out how
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
471 to allow Emacs keys in Insert state.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
472
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
473 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
474 * Emacs State:: This is the state you should learn more about when
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
475 you get up to speed with Viper.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
476 * Vi State:: Vi commands are executed in this state.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
477 * Insert State:: You can enter text, and also can do sophisticated
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
478 editing if you know enough Emacs commands.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
479 * Replace State:: Like Insert mode, but it is invoked via the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
480 replacement commands, such as cw, C, R, etc.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
481 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
482
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
483 @node Emacs State, Vi State, States in Viper, States in Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
484 @subsection Emacs State
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
485
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
486 @kindex @kbd{C-z}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
487 @cindex Emacs state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
488
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
489
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
490 You will be in this mode only by accident (hopefully). This is the state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
491 Emacs is normally in (imagine!!). Now leave it as soon as possible by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
492 typing @kbd{C-z}. Then you will be in Vi state (sigh of relief) :-).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
493
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
494 Emacs state is actually a Viperism to denote all the major and minor modes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
495 (@pxref{Emacs Preliminaries}) other than Viper that Emacs can be in. Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
496 can have several modes, such as C mode for editing C programs, LaTeX mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
497 for editing LaTeX documents, Dired for directory editing, etc. These are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
498 major modes, each with a different set of key-bindings. Viper states are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
499 orthogonal to these Emacs major modes. The presence of these language
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
500 sensitive and other modes is a major win over Vi. @xref{Improvements over
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
501 Vi}, for more.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
502
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
503 The bindings for these modes can be made available in the Viper Insert state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
504 as well as in Emacs state. Unless you specify your user level as 1 (a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
505 novice), all major mode key sequences that start with @kbd{C-x} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
506 @kbd{C-c} are also available in Vi state. This is important because major
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
507 modes designed for editing files, such as cc-mode or latex-mode, use key
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
508 sequences that begin with @kbd{C-x} and @kbd{C-c}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
509
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
510 There is also a key that lets you temporarily escape to Vi command state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
511 from Emacs or Insert states: typing @kbd{C-c \} will let you execute a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
512 single Vi command while staying in Viper's Emacs or Insert state.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
513 In Insert state, the same can also be achieved by typing @kbd{C-z}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
514
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
515
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
516 @node Vi State, Insert State, Emacs State, States in Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
517 @subsection Vi State
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
518
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
519 @cindex Vi state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
520
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
521 This is the Vi command mode. When Viper is in Vi state, you will see the sign
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
522 <V> in the mode line. Most keys will work as in Vi. The notable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
523 exceptions are:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
524
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
525 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
526 @item C-x
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
527 @kindex @kbd{C-x}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
528 @kbd{C-x} is used to invoke Emacs commands, mainly those that do window
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
529 management. @kbd{C-x 2} will split a window, @kbd{C-x 0} will close a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
530 window. @kbd{C-x 1} will close all other windows. @kbd{C-xb} is used to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
531 switch buffers in a window, and @kbd{C-xo} to move through windows.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
532 These are about the only necessary keystrokes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
533 For the rest, see the GNU Emacs Manual.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
534
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
535 @item C-c
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
536 @kindex @kbd{C-c}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
537 For user levels 2 and higher, this key serves as a prefix key for the key
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
538 sequences used by various major modes. For users at Viper level 1, @kbd{C-c}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
539 simply beeps.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
540
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
541 @item C-g and C-]
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
542 @kindex @kbd{C-g}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
543 @kindex @kbd{C-]}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
544
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
545 These are the Emacs @samp{quit} keys.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
546 There will be cases where you will have to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
547 use @kbd{C-g} to quit. Similarly, @kbd{C-]} is used to exit
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
548 @samp{Recursive Edits} in Emacs for which there is no comparable Vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
549 functionality and no key-binding. Recursive edits are indicated by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
550 @samp{[]} brackets framing the modes on the mode line.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
551 @xref{Recursive Edit,Recursive
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
552 Edit,Recursive Edit,emacs,The GNU Emacs Manual}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
553 At user level 1, @kbd{C-g} is bound to @code{viper-info-on-file}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
554 function instead.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
555 @refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
556 @item C-\
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
557 @kindex @kbd{C-\}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
558 @cindex Meta key
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
559
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
560 Viper uses @key{ESC} as a switch between Insert and Vi states. Emacs uses
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
561 @key{ESC} for Meta. The Meta key is very important in Emacs since many
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
562 finctions are accessible only via that key as @kbd{M-x function-name}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
563 Therefore, we need to simulate it somehow. In Viper's Vi, Insert, and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
564 Replace states, the meta key is set to be @kbd{C-\}. Thus, to get
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
565 @kbd{M-x}, you should type @kbd{C-\ x} (if the keyboard has no Meta key).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
566 This works both in the Vi command state and in the Insert and Replace
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
567 states. In Vi command state, you can also use @kbd{\ @key{ESC}} as the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
568 meta key.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
569
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
570 Note: Emacs binds @kbd{C-\} to a function that offers to change the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
571 keyboard input method in the multilingual environment. Viper overrides this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
572 binding. However, it is still possible to switch the input method by typing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
573 @kbd{\ C-\} in the Vi command state and @kbd{C-z \ C-\} in the Insert state.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
574 Or you can use the MULE menu in the menubar.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
575 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
576 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
577 Other differences are mostly improvements. The ones you should know
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
578 about are:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
579
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
580 @table @samp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
581 @item Undo
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
582 @kindex @kbd{u}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
583 @kbd{u} will undo. Undo can be repeated by the @kbd{.} key. Undo itself
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
584 can be undone. Another @kbd{u} will change the direction. The presence
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
585 of repeatable undo means that @kbd{U}, undoing lines, is not very
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
586 important. Therefore, @kbd{U} also calls @code{viper-undo}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
587 @cindex multiple undo
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
588 @cindex undo
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
589
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
590
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
591 @item Counts
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
592 Most commands, @kbd{~}, @kbd{[[}, @kbd{p}, @kbd{/}, @dots{}, etc., take counts.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
593
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
594 @comment ]] Just to balance parens
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
595 @item Regexps
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
596 Viper uses Emacs Regular Expressions for searches. These are a superset of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
597 Vi regular
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
598 expressions, excepting the change-of-case escapes @samp{\u}, @samp{\L},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
599 @dots{}, etc. @xref{Regular Expressions,,Regular Expressions,emacs,The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
600 GNU Emacs Manual}, for details.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
601 Files specified to @kbd{:e} use @code{csh} regular expressions
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
602 (globbing, wildcards, what have you).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
603 However, the function @code{viper-toggle-search-style}, bound to @kbd{C-c /},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
604 lets the user switch from search with regular expressions to plain vanilla
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
605 search and vice versa. It also lets one switch from case-sensitive search
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
606 to case-insensitive and back.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
607 @xref{Viper Specials}, for more details.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
608 @cindex regular expressions
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
609 @cindex vanilla search
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
610 @cindex case-sensitive search
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
611 @cindex case-insensitive search
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
612 @kindex @kbd{C-c /}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
613
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
614 @item Ex commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
615 @cindex Ex commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
616 The current working directory of a buffer is automatically inserted in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
617 minibuffer if you type @kbd{:e} then space. Absolute filenames are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
618 required less often in Viper. For path names, Emacs uses a convention that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
619 is slightly different from that of Unix. It is designed to minimize the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
620 need for deleting path names that Emacs provides in its prompts. (This is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
621 usually convenient, but occasionally the prompt may suggest a wrong path
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
622 name for you.) If you see a prompt @kbd{/usr/foo/} and you wish to edit the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
623 file @kbd{~/.viper}, you don't have to erase the prompt. Instead, simply
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
624 continue typing what you need. Emacs will interpret @kbd{/usr/foo/~/.viper}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
625 correctly. Similarly, if the prompt is @kbd{~/foo/} and you need to get to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
626 @kbd{/bar/file}, keep typing. Emacs interprets @kbd{~/foo//bar/} as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
627 @kbd{/bar/file}, since when it sees @samp{//}, it understands that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
628 @kbd{~/foo/} is to be discarded.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
629
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
630 The command @kbd{:cd} will change the default directory for the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
631 current buffer. The command @kbd{:e} will interpret the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
632 filename argument in @code{csh}. @xref{Customization}, if you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
633 want to change the default shell.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
634 The command @kbd{:next} takes counts from
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
635 @kbd{:args}, so that @kbd{:rew} is obsolete. Also, @kbd{:args} will show only
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
636 the invisible files (i.e., those that are not currently seen in Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
637 windows).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
638
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
639 When applicable, Ex commands support file completion and history. This
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
640 means that by typing a partial file name and then @key{TAB}, Emacs will try
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
641 to complete the name or it will offer a menu of possible completions.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
642 This works similarly to Tcsh and extends the behavior of Csh. While Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
643 is waiting for a file name, you can type @kbd{M-p} to get the previous file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
644 name you typed. Repeatedly typing @kbd{M-p} and @kbd{M-n} will let you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
645 browse through the file history.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
646
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
647 Like file names, partially typed Ex commands can be completed by typing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
648 @key{TAB}, and Viper keeps the history of Ex commands. After typing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
649 @kbd{:}, you can browse through the previously entered Ex commands by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
650 typing @kbd{M-p} and @kbd{M-n}. Viper tries to rationalize when it puts Ex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
651 commands on the history list. For instance, if you typed @kbd{:w!@: foo},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
652 only @kbd{:w!} will be placed on the history list. This is because the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
653 last history element is the default that can be invoked simply by typing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
654 @kbd{: @key{RET}}. If @kbd{:w!@: foo} were placed on the list, it would be all to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
655 easy to override valuable data in another file. Reconstructing the full
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
656 command, @kbd{:w!@: foo}, from the history is still not that hard, since Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
657 has a separate history for file names. By typing @kbd{: M-p}, you will get
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
658 @kbd{:w!} in the Minibuffer. Then, repeated @kbd{M-p} will get you through
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
659 the file history, inserting one file name after another.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
660
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
661 In contrast to @kbd{:w!@: foo}, if the command were @kbd{:r foo}, the entire
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
662 command will appear in the history list. This is because having @kbd{:r}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
663 alone as a default is meaningless, since this command requires a file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
664 argument.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
665 @refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
666 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
667 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
668 As Vi, Viper's destructive commands can be re-executed by typing `@kbd{.}'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
669 However, in addition, Viper keeps track of the history of such commands. This
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
670 history can be perused by typing @kbd{C-c M-p} and @kbd{C-c M-n}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
671 Having found the appropriate command, it can be then executed by typing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
672 `@kbd{.}'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
673 @xref{Improvements over Vi}, for more information.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
674
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
675 @node Insert State, Replace State, Vi State, States in Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
676 @subsection Insert State
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
677
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
678 @cindex Insert state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
679
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
680 To avoid confusing the beginner (at Viper level 1 and 2), Viper makes only the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
681 standard Vi keys available in Insert state. The implication is that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
682 Emacs major modes cannot be used Insert state.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
683 It is strongly recommended that as soon as you are comfortable, make the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
684 Emacs state bindings visible (by changing your user level to 3 or higher).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
685 @xref{Customization},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
686 to see how to do this.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
687
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
688 Once this is done, it is possible to do quite a bit of editing in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
689 Insert state. For instance, Emacs has a @dfn{yank} command, @kbd{C-y},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
690 which is similar to Vi's @kbd{p}. However, unlike @kbd{p}, @kbd{C-y} can be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
691 used in Insert state of Viper. Emacs also has a kill ring where it keeps
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
692 pieces of text you deleted while editing buffers. The command @kbd{M-y} is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
693 used to delete the text previously put back by Emacs' @kbd{C-y} or by Vi's
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
694 @kbd{p} command and reinsert text that was placed on the kill-ring earlier.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
695
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
696 This works both in Vi and Insert states.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
697 In Vi state, @kbd{M-y} is a much better alternative to the usual Vi's way
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
698 of recovering the 10 previously deleted chunks of text. In Insert state,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
699 you can
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
700 use this as follows. Suppose you deleted a piece of text and now you need
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
701 to re-insert it while editing in Insert mode. The key @kbd{C-y} will put
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
702 back the most recently deleted chunk. If this is not what you want, type
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
703 @kbd{M-y} repeatedly and, hopefully, you will find the chunk you want.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
704
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
705 Finally, in Insert and Replace states, Viper provides the history of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
706 pieces of text inserted in previous insert or replace commands. These
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
707 strings of text can be recovered by repeatedly typing @kbd{C-c M-p} or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
708 @kbd{C-c M-n} while in Insert or Replace state. (This feature is disabled
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
709 in the minibuffer: the above keys are usually bound to other histories,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
710 which are more appropriate in the minibuffer.)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
711
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
712
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
713 @cindex Meta key
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
714
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
715 You can call Meta functions from Insert state. As in Vi state, the Meta key
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
716 is @kbd{C-\}. Thus @kbd{M-x} is typed as @kbd{C-\ x}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
717
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
718 Other Emacs commands that are useful in Insert state are @kbd{C-e}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
719 and @kbd{C-a}, which move the cursor to the end and the beginning of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
720 current line, respectively. You can also use @kbd{M-f} and @kbd{M-b},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
721 which move the cursor forward (or backward) one word.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
722 If your display has a Meta key, these functions are invoked by holding the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
723 Meta key and then typing @kbd{f} and @kbd{b}, respectively. On displays
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
724 without the Meta key, these functions are invoked by typing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
725 @kbd{C-\ f} and @kbd{C-\ b} (@kbd{C-\} simulates the Meta key in Insert
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
726 state, as explained above).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
727
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
728 The key @kbd{C-z} is sometimes also useful in Insert state: it allows you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
729 to execute a single command in Vi state without leaving the Insert state!
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
730 For instance, @kbd{C-z d2w} will delete the next two words without leaving
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
731 the Insert state.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
732
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
733 When Viper is in Insert state, you will see <I> in the mode line.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
734
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
735 @node Replace State,, Insert State, States in Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
736 @subsection Replace State
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
737
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
738 @cindex Replace state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
739
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
740 This state is entered through Vi replacement commands, such as @kbd{C},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
741 @kbd{cw}, etc., or by typing @kbd{R}. In Replace state, Viper puts <R> in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
742 the mode line to let you know which state is in effect. If Replace state is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
743 entered through @kbd{R}, Viper stays in that state until the user hits
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
744 @key{ESC}. If this state is entered via the other replacement commands,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
745 then Replace state is in effect until you hit @key{ESC} or until you cross
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
746 the rightmost boundary of the replacement region. In the latter case, Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
747 changes its state from Replace to Insert (which you will notice by the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
748 change in the mode line).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
749
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
750 Since Viper runs under Emacs, it is possible to switch between buffers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
751 while in Replace state. You can also move the cursor using the arrow keys
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
752 (even on dumb terminals!)@: and the mouse. Because of this freedom (which is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
753 unattainable in regular Vi), it is possible to take the cursor outside the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
754 replacement region. (This may be necessary for several reasons, including
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
755 the need to enable text selection and region-setting with the mouse.)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
756
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
757 The issue then arises as to what to do when the user
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
758 hits the @key{ESC} key. In Vi, this would cause the text between cursor and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
759 the end of the replacement region to be deleted. But what if, as is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
760 possible in Viper, the cursor is not inside the replacement region?
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
761
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
762 To solve the problem, Viper keeps track of the last cursor position while it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
763 was still inside the replacement region. So, in the above situation, Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
764 would delete text between this position and the end of the replacement
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
765 region.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
766
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
767 @node The Minibuffer,Multiple Files in Viper, States in Viper, Overview
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
768 @section The Minibuffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
769
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
770 @cindex Minibuffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
771
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
772 The Minibuffer is where commands are entered in. Editing can be done
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
773 by commands from Insert state, namely:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
774
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
775 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
776 @item C-h
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
777 Backspace
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
778 @item C-w
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
779 Delete Word
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
780 @item C-u
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
781 Erase line
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
782 @item C-v
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
783 Quote the following character
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
784 @item @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
785 Execute command
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
786 @item C-g and C-]
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
787 Emacs quit and abort keys. These may be necessary. @xref{Vi State}, for an
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
788 explanation.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
789 @item M-p and M-n
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
790 These keys are bound to functions that peruse minibuffer history. The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
791 precise history to be perused depends on the context. It may be the history
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
792 of search strings, Ex commands, file names, etc.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
793 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
794
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
795 Most of the Emacs keys are functional in the Minibuffer. While in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
796 Minibuffer, Viper tries to make editing resemble Vi's behavior when the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
797 latter is waiting for the user to type an Ex command. In particular, you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
798 can use the regular Vi commands to edit the Minibuffer. You can switch
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
799 between the Vi state and Insert state at will, and even use the replace mode.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
800 Initially, the Minibuffer comes up in Insert state.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
801
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
802 Some users prefer plain Emacs bindings in the Minibuffer. To this end, set
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
803 @code{viper-vi-style-in-minibuffer} to @code{nil} in @file{.viper}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
804 @xref{Customization}, to learn how to do this.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
805
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
806 When the Minibuffer changes Viper states, you will notice that the appearance
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
807 of the text there changes as well. This is useful because the Minibuffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
808 has no mode line to tell which Vi state it is in.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
809 The appearance of the text in the Minibuffer can be changed.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
810 @xref{Viper Specials}, for more details.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
811
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
812 @node Multiple Files in Viper,Unimplemented Features,The Minibuffer,Overview
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
813 @section Multiple Files in Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
814
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
815 @cindex multiple files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
816 @cindex managing multiple files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
817
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
818 Viper can edit multiple files. This means, for example that you never need
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
819 to suffer through @code{No write since last change} errors.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
820 Some Viper elements are common over all the files.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
821
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
822 @table @samp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
823 @item Textmarkers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
824 @cindex markers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
825 @cindex textmarkers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
826 Textmarkers remember @emph{files and positions}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
827 If you set marker @samp{a} in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
828 file @file{foo}, start editing file @file{bar} and type @kbd{'a}, then
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
829 @emph{YOU WILL SWITCH TO FILE @file{foo}}. You can see the contents of a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
830 textmarker using the Viper command @kbd{[<a-z>} where <a-z> are the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
831 textmarkers, e.g., @kbd{[a} to view marker @samp{a} .@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
832 @item Repeated Commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
833 Command repetitions are common over files. Typing @kbd{!!} will repeat the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
834 last @kbd{!} command whichever file it was issued from.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
835 Typing @kbd{.} will repeat the last command from any file, and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
836 searches will repeat the last search. Ex commands can be repeated by typing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
837 @kbd{: @key{RET}}.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
838 Note: in some rare cases, that @kbd{: @key{RET}} may do something dangerous.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
839 However, usually its effect can be undone by typing @kbd{u}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
840 @item Registers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
841 @cindex registers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
842 Registers are common to files. Also, text yanked with @kbd{y} can be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
843 put back (@kbd{p}) into any file. The Viper command @kbd{]<a-z>}, where <a-z> are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
844 the registers, can be used to look at the contents of a register, e.g.,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
845 type @kbd{]a} to view register @samp{a}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
846
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
847 There is one difference in text deletion that you should be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
848 aware of. This difference comes from Emacs and was adopted in Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
849 because we find it very useful. In Vi, if you delete a line, say, and then
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
850 another line, these two deletions are separated and are put back
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
851 separately if you use the @samp{p} command. In Emacs (and Viper), successive
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
852 series of deletions that are @emph{not interrupted} by other commands are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
853 lumped together, so the deleted text gets accumulated and can be put back
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
854 as one chunk. If you want to break a sequence of deletions so that the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
855 newly deleted text could be put back separately from the previously deleted
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
856 text, you should perform a non-deleting action, e.g., move the cursor one
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
857 character in any direction.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
858 @item Absolute Filenames
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
859 @cindex absolute paths
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
860 The current directory name for a file is automatically prepended to the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
861 file name in any
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
862 @kbd{:e}, @kbd{:r}, @kbd{:w}, etc., command (in Emacs, each buffer has a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
863 current directory).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
864 This directory is inserted in the Minibuffer once you type space after
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
865 @kbd{:e, r}, etc. Viper also supports completion of file names and Ex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
866 commands (@key{TAB}), and it keeps track of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
867 command and file history (@kbd{M-p}, @kbd{M-n}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
868 Absolute filenames are required less
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
869 often in Viper.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
870
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
871 You should be aware that Emacs interprets @kbd{/foo/bar//bla} as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
872 @kbd{/bla} and @kbd{/foo/~/bar} as @kbd{~/bar}. This is designed to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
873 minimize the need for erasing path names that Emacs suggests in its
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
874 prompts, if a suggested path name is not what you wanted.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
875
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
876 The command @kbd{:cd} will change the default directory for the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
877 current Emacs buffer. The Ex command @kbd{:e} will interpret the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
878 filename argument in @samp{csh}, by default. @xref{Customization}, if you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
879 want to change this.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
880 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
881
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
882 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
883 Currently undisplayed files can be listed using the @kbd{:ar} command. The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
884 command @kbd{:n} can be given counts from the @kbd{:ar} list to switch to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
885 other files.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
886
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
887 @node Unimplemented Features,,Multiple Files in Viper,Overview
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
888 @section Unimplemented Features
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
889
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
890 Unimplemented features include:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
891
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
892 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
893 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
894 @kbd{:ab} and @kbd{:una} are not implemented.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
895 Both @kbd{:map} and @kbd{:ab} are considered obsolete, since Emacs has much
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
896 more powerful facilities for defining keyboard macros and abbreviations.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
897 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
898 @kbd{:set option?} is not implemented. The current
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
899 @kbd{:set} can also be used to set Emacs variables.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
900 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
901 @kbd{:se list} requires modification of the display code for Emacs, so
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
902 it is not implemented.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
903 A useful alternative is @code{cat -t -e file}. Unfortunately, it cannot
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
904 be used directly inside Emacs, since Emacs will obdurately change @samp{^I}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
905 back to normal tabs.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
906 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
907
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
908 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
909 @node Improvements over Vi, Customization, Overview, Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
910 @chapter Improvements over Vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
911
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
912 Some common problems with Vi and Ex have been solved in Viper. This
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
913 includes better implementation of existing commands, new commands, and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
914 the facilities provided by Emacs.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
915
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
916 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
917 * Basics:: Basic Viper differences, Multi-file effects.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
918 * Undo and Backups:: Multiple undo, auto-save, backups and changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
919 * History:: History for Ex and Vi commands.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
920 * Macros and Registers:: Keyboard Macros (extended ".")@: @@reg execution.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
921 * Completion:: Filename and Command Completion for Ex.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
922 * Improved Search:: Incremental Search and Buffer Content Search.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
923 * Abbreviation Facilities:: Normal Abbrevs, Templates, and Dynamic Abbrevs.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
924 * Movement and Markers:: Screen Editor movements, viewing textmarkers.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
925 * New Commands:: Commands that do not exist in Vi.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
926 * Useful Packages:: A Sampling of some Emacs packages, and things
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
927 you should know about.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
928 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
929
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
930 @node Basics, Undo and Backups, Improvements over Vi, Improvements over Vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
931 @section Basics
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
932
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
933 The Vi command set is based on the idea of combining motion commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
934 with other commands. The motion command is used as a text region
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
935 specifier for other commands.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
936 We classify motion commands into @dfn{point commands} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
937 @dfn{line commands}.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
938
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
939 @cindex point commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
940
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
941 The point commands are:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
942
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
943 @quotation
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
944 @kbd{h}, @kbd{l}, @kbd{0}, @kbd{$}, @kbd{w}, @kbd{W}, @kbd{b}, @kbd{B},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
945 @kbd{e}, @kbd{E}, @kbd{(}, @kbd{)}, @kbd{/}, @kbd{?}, @kbd{`}, @kbd{f},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
946 @kbd{F}, @kbd{t}, @kbd{T}, @kbd{%}, @kbd{;}, @kbd{,}, @kbd{^}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
947 @end quotation
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
948
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
949 @cindex line commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
950
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
951 The line commands are:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
952
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
953 @quotation
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
954 @kbd{j}, @kbd{k}, @kbd{+}, @kbd{-}, @kbd{H}, @kbd{M}, @kbd{L}, @kbd{@{},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
955 @kbd{@}}, @kbd{G}, @kbd{'}, @kbd{[[}, @kbd{]]}, @kbd{[]}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
956 @end quotation
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
957
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
958 @cindex region
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
959 @cindex region specification
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
960 @cindex expanding (region)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
961 @cindex describing regions
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
962 @cindex movement commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
963
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
964 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
965 If a point command is given as an argument to a modifying command, the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
966 region determined by the point command will be affected by the modifying
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
967 command. On the other hand, if a line command is given as an argument to a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
968 modifying command, the region determined by the line command will be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
969 enlarged so that it will become the smallest region properly containing the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
970 region and consisting of whole lines (we call this process @dfn{expanding
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
971 the region}), and then the enlarged region will be affected by the modifying
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
972 command.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
973 Text Deletion Commands (@pxref{Deleting Text}), Change commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
974 (@pxref{Changing Text}), even Shell Commands (@pxref{Shell Commands})
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
975 use these commands to describe a region of text to operate on.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
976 Thus, type @kbd{dw} to delete a word, @kbd{>@}} to shift a paragraph, or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
977 @kbd{!'afmt} to format a region from @samp{point} to textmarker
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
978 @samp{a}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
979
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
980 @cindex r and R region specifiers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
981
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
982 Viper adds the region specifiers @samp{r} and @samp{R}. Emacs has a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
983 special marker called @dfn{mark}. The text-area between the current cursor
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
984 position @dfn{point} and the @dfn{mark} is called the @dfn{region}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
985 @samp{r} specifies the raw region and @samp{R} is the expanded region
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
986 (i.e., the minimal contiguous chunk of full lines that contains the raw
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
987 region).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
988 @kbd{dr} will now delete the region, @kbd{>r} will shift it, etc.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
989 @kbd{r,R} are not motion commands, however. The special mark is set by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
990 @kbd{m.} and other commands. @xref{Marking}, for more info.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
991
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
992 Viper also adds counts to most commands for which it would make sense.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
993
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
994 In the Overview chapter, some Multiple File issues were discussed
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
995 (@pxref{Multiple Files in Viper}). In addition to the files, Emacs has
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
996 buffers. These can be seen in the @kbd{:args} list and switched using
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
997 @kbd{:next} if you type @kbd{:set ex-cycle-through-non-files t}, or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
998 specify @code{(setq ex-cycle-through-non-files t)} in your @file{.viper}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
999 file. @xref{Customization}, for details.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1000
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1001 @node Undo and Backups, History, Basics, Improvements over Vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1002 @section Undo and Backups
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1003
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1004 @cindex undo
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1005
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1006 Viper provides multiple undo. The number of undo's and the size is limited
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1007 by the machine. The Viper command @kbd{u} does an undo. Undo can be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1008 repeated by typing @kbd{.} (a period). Another @kbd{u} will undo the undo,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1009 and further
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1010 @kbd{.} will repeat it. Typing @kbd{u} does the first undo, and changes the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1011 direction.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1012
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1013 @cindex backup files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1014 @cindex auto save
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1015
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1016 Since the undo size is limited, Viper can create backup files and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1017 auto-save files. It will normally do this automatically. It is possible
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1018 to have numbered backups, etc. For details, @pxref{Backup,,Backup and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1019 Auto-Save,emacs,The GNU Emacs Manual} @refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1020
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1021 @comment [ balance parens
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1022 @cindex viewing registers and markers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1023 @cindex registers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1024 @cindex markers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1025 @cindex textmarkers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1026
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1027 The results of the 9 previous changes are available in the 9 numeric
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1028 registers, as in Vi. The extra goody is the ability to @emph{view} these
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1029 registers, in addition to being able to access them through @kbd{p} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1030 @kbd{M-y} (@xref{Insert State}, for details.)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1031 The Viper command @kbd{] register} will display the contents of any
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1032 register, numeric or alphabetical. The related command @kbd{[ textmarker}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1033 will show the text around the textmarker. @samp{register} and @samp{textmarker}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1034 can be any letters from a through z.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1035 @comment ] balance parens
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1036
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1037 @node History, Macros and Registers, Undo and Backups,Improvements over Vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1038 @section History
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1039
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1040 @cindex history
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1041 @cindex Minibuffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1042
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1043 History is provided for Ex commands, Vi searches, file names, pieces of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1044 text inserted in earlier commands that use Insert or Replace state, and for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1045 destructive commands in Vi state. These are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1046 useful for fixing those small typos that screw up searches and @kbd{:s},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1047 and for eliminating routine associated with repeated typing of file names
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1048 or pieces of text that need to be inserted frequently.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1049 At the @kbd{:} or @kbd{/} prompts in the Minibuffer, you can do the following:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1050
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1051 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1052 @item M-p and M-n
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1053 To move to previous and next history items. This causes the history
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1054 items to appear on the command line, where you can edit them, or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1055 simply type Return to execute.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1056 @item M-r and M-s
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1057 To search backward and forward through the history.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1058 @item @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1059 Type @key{RET} to accept a default (which is displayed in the prompt).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1060 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1061
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1062 The history of insertions can be perused by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1063 typing @kbd{C-c M-p} and @kbd{C-c M-n} while in Insert or Replace state.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1064 The history of destructive Vi commands can be perused via the same keys
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1065 when Viper is in Vi state. @xref{Viper Specials}, for details.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1066
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1067 All Ex commands have a file history. For instance, typing @kbd{:e}, space
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1068 and then @kbd{M-p} will bring up the name of the previously typed file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1069 name. Repeatedly typing @kbd{M-p}, @kbd{M-n}, etc., will let you browse
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1070 through the file history.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1071
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1072 Similarly, commands that have to do with switching buffers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1073 have a buffer history, and commands that expect strings or regular
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1074 expressions keep a history on those items.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1075
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1076 @node Macros and Registers,Completion,History,Improvements over Vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1077 @section Macros and Registers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1078
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1079 @cindex keyboard macros
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1080 @cindex macros
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1081 @cindex registers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1082 @cindex register execution
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1083
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1084 Viper facilitates the use of Emacs-style keyboard macros. @kbd{@@#} will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1085 start a macro definition. As you type, the commands will be executed, and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1086 remembered (This is called ``learn mode'' in some editors.)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1087 @kbd{@@register} will complete the macro, putting it into @samp{register},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1088 where @samp{register} is any character from @samp{a} through @samp{z}. Then
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1089 you can execute this macro using @kbd{@@register}. It is, of course,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1090 possible to yank some text into a register and execute it using
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1091 @kbd{@@register}. Typing @kbd{@@@@}, @kbd{@@RET}, or @kbd{@@C-j} will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1092 execute the last macro that was executed using @kbd{@@register}.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1093
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1094 Viper will automatically lowercase the register, so that pressing the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1095 @kbd{SHIFT} key for @kbd{@@} will not create problems. This is for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1096 @kbd{@@} macros and @kbd{"p} @emph{only}. In the case of @kbd{y},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1097 @kbd{"Ayy} will append to @emph{register a}. For @kbd{[,],',`}, it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1098 is an error to use a Uppercase register name.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1099
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1100 @comment [ balance parens
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1101 @cindex viewing registers and markers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1102
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1103 The contents of a register can be seen by @kbd{]register}. (@kbd{[textmarker}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1104 will show the contents of a textmarker).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1105 @comment ] balance parens
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1106
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1107 @cindex last keyboard macro
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1108
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1109 The last keyboard macro can also be executed using
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1110 @kbd{*}, and it can be yanked into a register using @kbd{@@!register}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1111 This is useful for Emacs style keyboard macros defined using @kbd{C-x(}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1112 and @kbd{C-x)}. Emacs keyboard macros have more capabilities.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1113 @xref{Keyboard Macros,,Keyboard Macros,emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}, for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1114 details.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1115
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1116 Keyboard Macros allow an interesting form of Query-Replace:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1117 @kbd{/pattern} or @kbd{n} to go to the next pattern (the query), followed by a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1118 Keyboard Macro execution @kbd{@@@@} (the replace).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1119
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1120 Viper also provides Vi-style macros. @xref{Vi Macros}, for details.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1121
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1122
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1123 @node Completion, Improved Search, Macros and Registers, Improvements over Vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1124 @section Completion
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1125
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1126 @cindex completion
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1127
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1128 Completion is done when you type @key{TAB}. The Emacs completer does not
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1129 grok wildcards in filenames. Once you type a wildcard, the completer will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1130 no longer work for that path. Remember that Emacs interprets a file name
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1131 of the form @kbd{/foo//bar} as @kbd{/bar} and @kbd{/foo/~/bar} as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1132 @kbd{~/bar}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1133
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1134 @node Improved Search, Abbreviation Facilities, Completion, Improvements over Vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1135 @section Improved Search
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1136
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1137 @cindex buffer search
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1138 @cindex word search
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1139
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1140 Viper provides buffer search, the ability to search the buffer for a region
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1141 under the cursor. You have to turn this on in @file{.viper} either by calling
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1142
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1143 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1144 (viper-buffer-search-enable)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1145 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1146
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1147 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1148 or by setting @code{viper-buffer-search-char} to, say, @kbd{f3}:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1149 @example
26263
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1150 (setq viper-buffer-search-char ?g)
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1151 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1152
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1153 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1154 If the user calls @code{viper-buffer-search-enable} explicitly (the first
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1155 method), then @code{viper-buffer-search-char} will be set to @kbd{g}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1156 Regardless of how this feature is enabled, the key
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1157 @code{viper-buffer-search-char} will take movement commands, like
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1158 @kbd{w,/,e}, to find a region and then search for the contents of that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1159 region. This command is very useful for searching for variable names, etc.,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1160 in a program. The search can be repeated by @kbd{n} or reversed by @kbd{N}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1161
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1162 @cindex incremental search
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1163
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1164 Emacs provides incremental search. As you type the string in, the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1165 cursor will move to the next match. You can snarf words from the buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1166 as you go along. Incremental Search is normally bound to @kbd{C-s} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1167 @kbd{C-r}. @xref{Customization}, to find out how to change the bindings
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1168 of @kbd{C-r or C-s}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1169 For details, @pxref{Incremental Search,,Incremental
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1170 Search,emacs,The GNU Emacs Manual} @refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1171
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1172 @cindex query replace
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1173
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1174 Viper also provides a query replace function that prompts through the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1175 Minibuffer. It is invoked by the @kbd{Q} key in Vi state.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1176
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1177 @cindex mouse search
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1178
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1179 On a window display, Viper supports mouse search, i.e., you can search for a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1180 word by clicking on it. @xref{Viper Specials}, for details.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1181
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1182 Finally, on a window display, Viper highlights search patterns as it finds
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1183 them. This is done through what is known as @emph{faces} in Emacs. The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1184 variable that controls how search patterns are highlighted is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1185 @code{viper-search-face}. If you don't want any highlighting at all, put
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1186 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1187 (copy-face 'default 'viper-search-face)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1188 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1189 @vindex @code{viper-search-face}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1190 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1191 in @file{~/.viper}. If you want to change how patterns are highlighted, you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1192 will have to change @code{viper-search-face} to your liking. The easiest
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1193 way to do this is to use Emacs customization widget, which is accessible
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1194 from the menubar. Viper customization group is located under the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1195 @emph{Emulations} customization group, which in turn is under the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1196 @emph{Editing} group. All Viper faces are grouped together under Viper's
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1197 @emph{Highlighting} group.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1198
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1199 Try it: it is really simple!
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1200
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1201 @node Abbreviation Facilities,Movement and Markers,Improved Search,Improvements over Vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1202 @section Abbreviation Facilities
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1203
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1204 @cindex abbrevs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1205
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1206 It is possible in Emacs to define abbrevs based on the contents of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1207 buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1208 Sophisticated templates can be defined using the Emacs abbreviation
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1209 facilities. @xref{Abbrevs,,Abbreviations,emacs,The GNU Emacs Manual}, for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1210 details.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1211
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1212 @cindex dynamic abbrevs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1213
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1214 Emacs also provides Dynamic Abbreviations. Given a partial word, Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1215 will search the buffer to find an extension for this word. For instance,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1216 one can type @samp{Abbreviations} by typing @samp{A}, followed by a keystroke
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1217 that completed the @samp{A} to @samp{Abbreviations}. Repeated typing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1218 will search further back in the buffer, so that one could get
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1219 @samp{Abbrevs} by repeating the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1220 keystroke, which appears earlier in the text. Emacs binds this to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1221 @kbd{@key{ESC} /}, so you will have to find a key and bind the function
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1222 @code{dabbrev-expand} to that key.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1223 Facilities like this make Vi's @kbd{:ab} command obsolete.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1224
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1225 @node Movement and Markers, New Commands, Abbreviation Facilities, Improvements over Vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1226 @section Movement and Markers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1227
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1228 @cindex Ex style motion
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1229 @cindex line editor motion
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1230
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1231 Viper can be set free from the line--limited movements in Vi, such as @kbd{l}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1232 refusing to move beyond the line, @key{ESC} moving one character back,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1233 etc. These derive from Ex, which is a line editor. If your @file{.viper}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1234 contains
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1235
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1236 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1237 @code{(setq viper-ex-style-motion nil)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1238 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1239
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1240 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1241 the motion will be a true screen editor motion. One thing you must then
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1242 watch out for is that it is possible to be on the end-of-line character.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1243 The keys @kbd{x} and @kbd{%} will still work correctly, i.e., as if they
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1244 were on the last character.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1245
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1246 @vindex @code{viper-syntax-preference}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1247 @cindex syntax table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1248
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1249 The word-movement commands @kbd{w}, @kbd{e}, etc., and the associated
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1250 deletion/yanking commands, @kbd{dw}, @kbd{yw}, etc., can be made to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1251 understand Emacs syntax tables. If the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1252 @code{viper-syntax-preference} is set to @code{strict-vi} then
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1253 the meaning of @emph{word} is the same as in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1254 Vi. However, if the value is @code{reformed-vi} (the default) then the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1255 alphanumeric symbols will be those specified by the current Emacs syntax
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1256 table (which may be different for different major modes) plus the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1257 underscore symbol @kbd{_}, minus some non-word symbols, like '.;,|, etc.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1258 Both @code{strict-vi} and @code{reformed-vi} work close to Vi in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1259 traditional cases, but @code{reformed-vi} does a better job when editing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1260 text in non-Latin alphabets.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1261
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1262 The user can also specify the value @code{emacs}, which would
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1263 make Viper use exactly the Emacs notion of word. In particular, the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1264 underscore may not be part of a word. Finally, if
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1265 @code{viper-syntax-preference} is set to @code{extended}, Viper words would
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1266 consist of characters that are classified as alphanumeric @emph{or} as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1267 parts of symbols. This is convenient for writing programs and in many other
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1268 situations.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1269
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1270 @code{viper-syntax-preference} is a local variable, so it can have different
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1271 values for different major modes. For instance, in programming modes it can
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1272 have the value @code{extended}. In text modes where words contain special
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1273 characters, such as European (non-English) letters, Cyrillic letters, etc.,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1274 the value can be @code{reformed-vi} or @code{emacs}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1275
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1276 Changes to @code{viper-syntax-preference} should be done in the hooks to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1277 various major modes by executing @code{viper-set-syntax-preference} as in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1278 the following example:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1279
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1280 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1281 (viper-set-syntax-preference nil "emacs")
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1282 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1283
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1284 @findex @code{viper-set-syntax-preference}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1285
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1286 The above discussion of the meaning of Viper's words concerns only Viper's
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1287 movement commands. In regular expressions, words remain the same as in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1288 Emacs. That is, the expressions @code{\w}, @code{\>}, @code{\<}, etc., use
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1289 Emacs' idea of what is a word, and they don't look into the value of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1290 variable @code{viper-syntax-preference}. This is because Viper doesn't change
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1291 syntax tables in fear of upsetting the various major modes that set these
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1292 tables.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1293
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1294 @cindex textmarkers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1295
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1296 Textmarkers in Viper remember the file and the position, so that you can
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1297 switch files by simply doing @kbd{'a}. If you set up a regimen for using
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1298 Textmarkers, this is very useful. Contents of textmarkers can be viewed
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1299 by @kbd{[marker}. (Contents of registers can be viewed by @kbd{]register}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1300
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1301 @node New Commands, Useful Packages, Movement and Markers, Improvements over Vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1302 @section New Commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1303
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1304 These commands have no Vi analogs.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1305
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1306 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1307 @item C-x, C-c
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1308 @kindex @kbd{C-x}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1309 @kindex @kbd{C-c}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1310 These two keys invoke many important Emacs functions. For example, if you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1311 hit @kbd{C-x} followed by @kbd{2}, then the current window will be split
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1312 into 2. Except for novice users, @kbd{C-c} is also set to execute an Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1313 command from the current major mode. @key{ESC} will do the same, if you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1314 configure @key{ESC} as Meta by setting @code{viper-no-multiple-ESC} to nil
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1315 in @file{.viper}. @xref{Customization}. @kbd{C-\} in Insert, Replace, or Vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1316 states will make Emacs think @kbd{Meta} has been hit.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1317 @item \
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1318 @kindex @kbd{\}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1319 Escape to Emacs to execute a single Emacs command. For instance,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1320 @kbd{\ @key{ESC}} will act like a Meta key.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1321 @item Q
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1322 @kindex @kbd{Q}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1323 @cindex query replace
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1324 @kbd{Q} is for query replace. By default,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1325 each string to be replaced is treated as a regular expression. You can use
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1326 @code{(setq viper-re-query-replace nil)} in your @file{.emacs} file to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1327 turn this off. (For normal searches, @kbd{:se nomagic} will work. Note
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1328 that @kbd{:se nomagic} turns Regexps off completely, unlike Vi).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1329 @item v
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1330 @itemx V
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1331 @itemx C-v
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1332 @kindex @kbd{v}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1333 @kindex @kbd{V}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1334 @kindex @kbd{C-v}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1335 These keys are used to visit files. @kbd{v} will switch to a buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1336 visiting file whose name can be entered in the Minibuffer. @kbd{V} is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1337 similar, but will use a window different from the current window.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1338 @kbd{C-v} is like @kbd{V}, except that a new frame (X window) will be used
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1339 instead of a new Emacs window.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1340 @item #
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1341 @kindex @kbd{#}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1342 If followed by a certain character @var{ch}, it becomes an operator whose
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1343 argument is the region determined by the motion command that follows
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1344 (indicated as <move>).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1345 Currently, @var{ch} can be one of @kbd{c}, @kbd{C}, @kbd{g}, @kbd{q}, and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1346 @kbd{s}. For instance, @kbd{#qr} will prompt you for a string and then
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1347 prepend this string to each line in the buffer.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1348 @item # c
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1349 @kindex @kbd{#c<move>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1350 @cindex changing case
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1351 Change upper-case characters in the region to lower-case
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1352 (@code{downcase-region}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1353 Emacs command @kbd{M-l} does the same for words.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1354 @item # C
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1355 @kindex @kbd{#C<move>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1356 Change lower-case characters in the region to upper-case. For instance,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1357 @kbd{# C 3 w} will capitalize 3 words from the current point
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1358 (@code{upcase-region}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1359 Emacs command @kbd{M-u} does the same for words.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1360 @item # g
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1361 @kindex @kbd{#g<move>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1362 Execute last keyboard macro for each line in the region
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1363 (@code{viper-global-execute}).@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1364 @item # q
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1365 @kindex @kbd{#q<move>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1366 Insert specified string at the beginning of each line in the region
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1367 (@code{viper-quote-region}). The default string is composed of the comment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1368 character(s) appropriate for the current major mode.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1369 @item # s
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1370 @kindex @kbd{#s<move>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1371 Check spelling of words in the region (@code{spell-region}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1372 The function used for spelling is determined from the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1373 @code{viper-spell-function}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1374 @vindex @code{viper-spell-function}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1375 @item *
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1376 @kindex @kbd{*}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1377 Call last keyboard macro.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1378 @item m .
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1379 Set mark at point and push old mark off the ring
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1380 @item m<
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1381 @item m>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1382 Set mark at beginning and end of buffer, respectively.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1383 @item m,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1384 Jump to mark and pop mark off the ring. @xref{Mark,,Mark,emacs,The GNU
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1385 Emacs Manual}, for more info.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1386 @item ] register
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1387 @kindex @kbd{]<a-z>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1388 View contents of register
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1389 @item [ textmarker
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1390 @kindex @kbd{[<a-z>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1391 View filename and position of textmarker
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1392 @item @@#
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1393 @item @@register
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1394 @item @@!
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1395 @kindex @kbd{@@#}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1396 @kindex @kbd{@@<a-z>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1397 @kindex @kbd{@@!}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1398 @cindex keyboard macros
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1399 @cindex register execution
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1400
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1401 Begin/end keyboard macro. @@register has a different meaning when used after
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1402 a @kbd{@@#}. @xref{Macros and Registers}, for details
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1403 @item []
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1404 @kindex @kbd{[]}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1405 Go to end of heading.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1406 @item g <@emph{movement command}>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1407 Search buffer for text delimited by movement command. The canonical
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1408 example is @kbd{gw} to search for the word under the cursor.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1409 @xref{Improved Search}, for details.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1410 @item C-g and C-]
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1411 @kindex @kbd{C-g}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1412 @kindex @kbd{C-]}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1413 Quit and Abort Recursive edit. These may be necessary on occasion.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1414 @xref{Vi State}, for a reason.
26263
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1415 @item C-c C-g
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1416 @kindex @kbd{C-c C-g}
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1417 Hitting @kbd{C-c} followed by @kbd{C-g} will display the information on the
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1418 current buffer. This is the same as hitting @kbd{C-g} in Vi, but, as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1419 explained above, @kbd{C-g} is needed for other purposes in Emacs.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1420 @item C-c /
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1421 @kindex @kbd{C-c /}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1422 Without a prefix argument, this command toggles
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1423 case-sensitive/case-insensitive search modes and plain vanilla/regular
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1424 expression search. With the prefix argument 1, i.e.,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1425 @kbd{1 C-c /}, this toggles case-sensitivity; with the prefix argument 2,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1426 toggles plain vanilla search and search using
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1427 regular expressions. @xref{Viper Specials}, for alternative ways to invoke
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1428 this function.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1429 @cindex vanilla search
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1430 @cindex case-sensitive search
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1431 @cindex case-insensitive search
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1432
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1433 @item M-p and M-n
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1434 @kindex @kbd{M-p}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1435 @kindex @kbd{M-n}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1436 In the Minibuffer, these commands navigate through the minibuffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1437 histories, such as the history of search strings, Ex commands, etc.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1438
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1439 @item C-c M-p and C-c M-n
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1440 @kindex @kbd{C-c M-p}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1441 @kindex @kbd{C-c M-n}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1442 @cindex Insertion history
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1443 @cindex Insertion ring
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1444 @cindex Command history
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1445 @cindex Command ring
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1446
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1447 In Insert or Replace state, these commands let the user
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1448 peruse the history of insertion strings used in previous insert or replace
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1449 commands. Try to hit @kbd{C-c M-p} or @kbd{C-c M-n} repeatedly and see what
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1450 happens. @xref{Viper Specials}, for more.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1451
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1452 In Vi state, these commands let the user peruse the history of Vi-style
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1453 destructive commands, such as @kbd{dw}, @kbd{J}, @kbd{a}, etc.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1454 By repeatedly typing @kbd{C-c M-p} or @kbd{C-c M-n} you will cycle Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1455 through the recent history of Vi commands, displaying the commands one by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1456 one. Once
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1457 an appropriate command is found, it can be executed by typing `@kbd{.}'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1458
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1459 Since typing @kbd{C-c M-p} is tedious, it is more convenient to bind an
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1460 appropriate function to a function key on the keyboard and use that key.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1461 @xref{Viper Specials}, for details.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1462
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1463 @item Ex commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1464 @findex @kbd{:args}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1465 @findex @kbd{:n}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1466 @findex @kbd{:pwd}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1467 @findex @kbd{:pre}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1468 The commands @kbd{:args}, @kbd{:next}, @kbd{:pre} behave
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1469 differently. @kbd{:pwd} exists to get current directory.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1470 The commands @kbd{:b} and @kbd{:B} switch buffers around. @xref{File and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1471 Buffer Handling}, for details.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1472 There are also the new commands @kbd{:RelatedFile} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1473 @kbd{PreviousRelatedFile} (which abbreviate to @kbd{R} and @kbd{P},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1474 respectively. @xref{Viper Specials}, for details.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1475 @findex @kbd{:RelatedFile}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1476 @findex @kbd{:PreviousRelatedFile}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1477 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1478
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1479 Apart from the new commands, many old commands have been enhanced. Most
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1480 notably, Vi style macros are much more powerful in Viper than in Vi. @xref{Vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1481 Macros}, for details.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1482
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1483 @node Useful Packages, ,New Commands, Improvements over Vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1484 @section Useful Packages
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1485
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1486 Some Emacs packages are mentioned here as an aid to the new Viper user, to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1487 indicate what Viper is capable of.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1488 A vast number comes with the standard Emacs distribution, and many more exist
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1489 on the net and on the archives.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1490
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1491 This manual also mentions some Emacs features a new user
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1492 should know about. The details of these are found in the GNU Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1493 Manual.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1494
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1495 The features first. For details, look up the Emacs Manual.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1496
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1497 @table @samp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1498 @item Make
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1499 @cindex make
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1500 @cindex compiling
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1501
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1502 Makes and Compiles can be done from the editor. Error messages will be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1503 parsed and you can move to the error lines.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1504 @item Shell
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1505 @cindex shell
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1506 @cindex interactive shell
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1507 You can talk to Shells from inside the editor. Your entire shell session
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1508 can be treated as a file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1509 @item Mail
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1510 @cindex email
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1511 @cindex mail
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1512 Mail can be read from and sent within the editor. Several sophisticated
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1513 packages exist.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1514 @item Language Sensitive Editing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1515 Editing modes are written for most computer languages in existence. By
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1516 controlling indentation, they catch punctuation errors.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1517 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1518
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1519 The packages, below, represents a drop in the sea of special-purpose
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1520 packages that come with standard distribution of Emacs.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1521
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1522 @table @samp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1523 @item Transparent FTP
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1524 @cindex transparent ftp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1525 @pindex ange-ftp.el
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1526 @code{ange-ftp.el} can ftp from the editor to files on other machines
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1527 transparent to the user.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1528 @item RCS Interfaces
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1529 @cindex version maintenance
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1530 @cindex RCS
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1531 @pindex vc.el
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1532 @code{vc.el} for doing RCS commands from inside the editor
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1533 @item Directory Editor
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1534 @cindex dired
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1535 @pindex dired.el
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1536 @code{dired.el} for editing contents of directories and for navigating in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1537 the file system.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1538 @item Syntactic Highlighting
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1539 @cindex font-lock
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1540 @pindex font-lock.el
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1541 @code{font-lock.el} for automatic highlighting various parts of a buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1542 using different fonts and colors.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1543 @item Saving Emacs Configuration
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1544 @cindex desktop
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1545 @pindex desktop.el
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1546 @code{desktop.el} for saving/restoring configuration on Emacs exit/startup.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1547 @item Spell Checker
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1548 @cindex ispell
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1549 @pindex ispell.el
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1550 @code{ispell.el} for spell checking the buffer, words, regions, etc.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1551 @item File and Buffer Comparison
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1552 @cindex ediff
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1553 @pindex ediff.el
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1554 @code{ediff.el} for finding differences between files and for applying
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1555 patches.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1556 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1557
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1558 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1559 Emacs Lisp archives exist on
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1560 @samp{archive.cis.ohio-state.edu}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1561 and @samp{wuarchive.wustl.edu}@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1562
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1563
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1564 @node Customization,Commands,Improvements over Vi,Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1565 @chapter Customization
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1566
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1567 @cindex customization
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1568
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1569 Customization can be done in 2 ways.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1570
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1571 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1572 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1573 @cindex initialization
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1574 @cindex .viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1575 Elisp code in a @file{.viper} file in your home directory. Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1576 loads @file{.viper} just before it does the binding for mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1577 hooks. This is the recommended method.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1578 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1579 @cindex .emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1580 Elisp code in your @file{.emacs} file before and after the @code{(require
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1581 'viper)} line. This method is not recommended, unless you know what you are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1582 doing. Only two variables, @code{viper-mode} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1583 @code{viper-custom-file-name} are supposed to be customized in @file{.emacs},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1584 prior to loading Viper.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1585 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1586
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1587 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1588 Most of Viper's behavior can be customized via the interactive Emacs user
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1589 interface. Choose "Customize" from the menubar, click on "Editing", then on
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1590 "Emulations". The customization widget is self-explanatory. Once you are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1591 satisfied with your changes, save them into a file and then include the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1592 contents of that file in the Viper customization repository, @file{.viper}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1593 (except for @code{viper-mode} and @code{viper-custom-file-name}, which are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1594 supposed to go into @code{.emacs}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1595
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1596 Some advanced customization cannot be accomplished this way, however, and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1597 has to be done in Emacs Lisp. For the common cases, examples are provided
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1598 that you can use directly.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1599
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1600 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1601 * Rudimentary Changes:: Simple constant definitions.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1602 * Keybindings:: Enabling Emacs Keys, Rebinding keys, etc.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1603 * Packages that Change Keymaps:: How to deal with such beasts.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1604 * Viper Specials:: Special Viper commands.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1605 * Vi Macros:: How to do Vi style macros.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1606 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1607
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1608 @node Rudimentary Changes,Keybindings,Customization,Customization
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1609 @section Rudimentary Changes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1610
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1611 @cindex setting variables
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1612 @cindex variables for customization
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1613 @findex @kbd{:set}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1614
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1615 An easy way to customize Viper is to change the values of constants used in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1616 Viper. Here is the list of the constants used in Viper and their default
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1617 values. The corresponding :se command is also indicated. (The symbols
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1618 @code{t} and @code{nil} represent ``true'' and ``false'' in Lisp).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1619
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1620 Viper supports both the abbreviated Vi variable names and their full
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1621 names. Variable completion is done on full names only. @key{TAB} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1622 @key{SPC} complete
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1623 variable names. Typing `=' will complete the name and then will prompt for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1624 a value, if applicable. For instance, @kbd{:se au @key{SPC}} will complete the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1625 command to @kbd{:set autoindent}; @kbd{:se ta @key{SPC}} will complete the command
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1626 and prompt further like this: @kbd{:set tabstop = }.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1627 However, typing @kbd{:se ts @key{SPC}} will produce a ``No match'' message
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1628 because @kbd{ts} is an abbreviation for @kbd{tabstop} and Viper supports
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1629 completion on full names only. However, you can still hit @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1630 or @kbd{=}, which will complete the command like this: @kbd{:set ts = } and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1631 Viper will be waiting for you to type a value for the tabstop variable.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1632 To get the full list of Vi variables, type @kbd{:se @key{SPC} @key{TAB}}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1633
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1634 @table @code
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1635 @item viper-auto-indent nil
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1636 @itemx :se ai (:se autoindent)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1637 @itemx :se ai-g (:se autoindent-global)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1638 If @code{t}, enable auto indentation.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1639 by @key{RET}, @kbd{o} or @kbd{O} command.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1640
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1641 @code{viper-auto-indent} is a local variable. To change the value globally, use
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1642 @code{setq-default}. It may be useful for certain major modes to have their
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1643 own values of @code{viper-auto-indent}. This can be achieved by using
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1644 @code{setq} to change the local value of this variable in the hooks to the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1645 appropriate major modes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1646
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1647 @kbd{:se ai} changes the value of @code{viper-auto-indent} in the current
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1648 buffer only; @kbd{:se ai-g} does the same globally.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1649 @item viper-electric-mode t
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1650 If not @code{nil}, auto-indentation becomes electric, which means that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1651 @key{RET}, @kbd{O}, and @kbd{o} indent cursor according to the current
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1652 major mode. In the future, this variable may control additional electric
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1653 features.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1654
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1655 This is a local variable: @code{setq} changes the value of this variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1656 in the current buffer only. Use @code{setq-default} to change the value in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1657 all buffers.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1658 @item viper-case-fold-search nil
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1659 @itemx :se ic (:se ignorecase)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1660 If not @code{nil}, search ignores cases.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1661 This can also be toggled by quickly hitting @kbd{/} twice.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1662 @item viper-re-search nil
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1663 @itemx :se magic
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1664 If not @code{nil}, search will use regular expressions; if @code{nil} then
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1665 use vanilla search.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1666 This behavior can also be toggled by quickly hitting @kbd{/} trice.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1667 @item buffer-read-only
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1668 @itemx :se ro (:se readonly)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1669 Set current buffer to read only. To change globally put
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1670 @code{(setq-default buffer-read-only t)} in your @file{.emacs} file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1671 @item blink-matching-paren t
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1672 @itemx :se sm (:se showmatch)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1673 Show matching parens by blinking cursor.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1674 @item tab-width t (default setting via @code{setq-default})
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1675 @itemx :se ts=value (:se tabstop=value)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1676 @itemx :se ts-g=value (:se tabstop-global=value)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1677 @code{tab-width} is a local variable that controls the width of the tab stops.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1678 To change the value globally, use @code{setq-default}; for local settings,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1679 use @code{setq}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1680
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1681 The command @kbd{:se ts}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1682 sets the tab width in the current
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1683 buffer only; it has no effect on other buffers.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1684
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1685 The command @kbd{:se ts-g} sets tab width globally,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1686 for all buffers where the tab is not yet set locally,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1687 including the new buffers.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1688
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1689 Note that typing @key{TAB} normally
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1690 doesn't insert the tab, since this key is usually bound to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1691 a text-formatting function, @code{indent-for-tab-command} (which facilitates
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1692 programming and document writing). Instead, the tab is inserted via the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1693 command @code{viper-insert-tab}, which is bound to @kbd{S-tab} (shift + tab).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1694
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1695 On some non-windowing terminals, Shift doesn't modify the @key{TAB} key, so
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1696 @kbd{S-tab} behaves as if it were @key{TAB}. In such a case, you will have
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1697 to bind @code{viper-insert-tab} to some other convenient key.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1698
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1699 @item viper-shift-width 8
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1700 @itemx :se sw=value (:se shiftwidth=value)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1701 The number of columns shifted by @kbd{>} and @kbd{<} commands.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1702 @item viper-search-wrap-around t
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1703 @itemx :se ws (:se wrapscan)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1704 If not @code{nil}, search wraps around the end/beginning of buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1705 @item viper-search-scroll-threshold 2
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1706 If search lands within this many lines of the window top or bottom, the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1707 window will be scrolled up or down by about 1/7-th of its size, to reveal
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1708 the context. If the value is negative---don't scroll.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1709 @item viper-tags-file-name "TAGS"
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1710 The name of the file used as the tag table.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1711 @item viper-re-query-replace nil
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1712 If not @code{nil}, use reg-exp replace in query replace.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1713 @item viper-want-ctl-h-help nil
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1714 If not @code{nil}, @kbd{C-h} is bound to @code{help-command};
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1715 otherwise, @kbd{C-h} is bound as usual in Vi.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1716 @item viper-vi-style-in-minibuffer t
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1717 If not @code{nil}, Viper provides a high degree of compatibility with Vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1718 insert mode when you type text in the Minibuffer; if @code{nil}, typing in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1719 the Minibuffer feels like plain Emacs.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1720 @item viper-no-multiple-ESC t
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1721 If you set this to @code{nil}, you can use @key{ESC} as Meta in Vi state.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1722 Normally, this is not necessary, since graphical displays have separate
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1723 Meta keys (usually on each side of the space bar). On a dumb terminal, Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1724 sets this variable to @code{twice}, which is almost like @code{nil}, except
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1725 that double @key{ESC} beeps. This, too, lets @key{ESC} to be used as a Meta.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1726 @item viper-ESC-keyseq-timeout 200 on tty, 0 on windowing display
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1727 Escape key sequences separated by this much delay (in milliseconds) are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1728 interpreted as command, ignoring the special meaning of @key{ESC} in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1729 VI. The default is suitable for most terminals. However, if your terminal
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1730 is extremely slow, you might want to increase this slightly. You will know
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1731 if your terminal is slow if the @key{ESC} key sequences emitted by the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1732 arrow keys are interpreted as separately typed characters (and thus the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1733 arrow keys won't work). Making this value too large will slow you down, so
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1734 exercise restraint.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1735 @item viper-fast-keyseq-timeout 200
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1736 Key sequences separated by this many milliseconds are treated as Vi-style
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1737 keyboard macros. If the key sequence is defined as such a macro, it will be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1738 executed. Otherwise, it is processed as an ordinary sequence of typed keys.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1739
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1740 Setting this variable too high may slow down your typing. Setting it too
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1741 low may make it hard to type macros quickly enough.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1742 @item viper-ex-style-motion t
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1743 Set this to @code{nil}, if you want @kbd{l,h} to cross
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1744 lines, etc. @xref{Movement and Markers}, for more info.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1745 @item viper-ex-style-editing t
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1746 Set this to to @code{nil}, if you want
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1747 @kbd{C-h} and @key{DEL} to not stop
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1748 at the beginning of a line in Insert state, @key{X} and @key{x} to delete
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1749 characters across lines in Vi command state, etc.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1750 @item viper-ESC-moves-cursor-back t
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1751 It t, cursor moves back 1 character when switching from insert state to vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1752 state. If nil, the cursor stays where it was before the switch.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1753 @item viper-always t
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1754 @code{t} means: leave it to Viper to decide when a buffer must be brought
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1755 up in Vi state,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1756 Insert state, or Emacs state. This heuristics works well in virtually all
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1757 cases. @code{nil} means you either has to invoke @code{viper-mode} manually
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1758 for each buffer (or you can add @code{viper-mode} to the appropriate major mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1759 hooks using @code{viper-load-hook}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1760
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1761 This option must be set in the file @file{~/.viper}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1762 @item viper-custom-file-name "~/.viper"
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1763 File used for Viper-specific customization.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1764 Change this setting, if you want. Must be set in @file{.emacs} (not @file{.viper}!)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1765 before Viper is loaded. Note that you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1766 have to set it as a string inside double quotes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1767 @item viper-spell-function 'ispell-region
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1768 Function used by the command @kbd{#c<move>} to spell.
26263
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1769 @item viper-glob-function
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1770 The value of this variable is the function symbol used to expand wildcard
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1771 symbols. This is platform-dependent. The default tries to set this variable
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1772 to work with most Unix shells, MS Windows, OS/2, etc. However, if it
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1773 doesn't work the way you expect, you should write your own.
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1774 Use @code{viper-glob-unix-files} and @code{viper-glob-mswindows-files} in
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1775 @file{viper-util.el} as examples.
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1776
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1777 This feature is used to expand wildcards in the Ex command @kbd{:e}.
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1778 Note that Viper doesn't support wildcards in the @kbd{:r} and @kbd{:w}
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1779 commands, because file completion is a better mechanism.
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1780 @findex @code{viper-glob-function}
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
1781
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1782 @item ex-cycle-other-window t
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1783 If not @code{nil}, @kbd{:n} and @kbd{:b} will cycle through files in another
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1784 window, if one exists.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1785 @item ex-cycle-through-non-files nil
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1786 @kbd{:n} does not normally cycle through buffers. Set this to get
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1787 buffers also.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1788 @item viper-want-emacs-keys-in-insert
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1789 This is set to @code{nil} for user levels 1 and 2 and to @code{t} for user
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1790 levels 3 and 4. Users who specify level 5 are allowed to set this variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1791 as they please (the default for this level is @code{t}). If set to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1792 @code{nil}, complete Vi compatibility is provided in Insert state. This is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1793 really not recommended, as this precludes you from using language-specific
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1794 features provided by the major modes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1795 @item viper-want-emacs-keys-in-vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1796 This is set to @code{nil} for user
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1797 level 1 and to @code{t} for user levels 2--4.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1798 At level 5, users are allowed to set this variable as they please (the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1799 default for this level is @code{t}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1800 If set to @code{nil}, complete Vi compatibility is provided
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1801 in Vi command state. Setting this to @code{nil} is really a bad idea,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1802 unless you are a novice, as this precludes the use
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1803 of language-specific features provided by the major modes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1804 @item viper-keep-point-on-repeat t
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1805 If not @code{nil}, point is not moved when the user repeats the previous
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1806 command by typing `.' This is very useful for doing repeated changes with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1807 the @kbd{.} key.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1808 @item viper-repeat-from-history-key 'f12
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1809 Prefix key used to invoke the macros @kbd{f12 1} and @kbd{f12 2} that repeat
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1810 the second-last and the third-last destructive command.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1811 Both these macros are bound (as Viper macros) to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1812 @code{viper-repeat-from-history},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1813 which checks the second key by which it is invoked to see which of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1814 previous commands to invoke. Viper binds @kbd{f12 1} and @kbd{f12 2} only,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1815 but the user can bind more in @file{~/.viper}. @xref{Vi Macros}, for how to do
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1816 this.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1817 @item viper-keep-point-on-undo nil
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1818 If not @code{nil}, Viper tries to not move point when undoing commands.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1819 Instead, it will briefly move the cursor to the place where change has
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1820 taken place. However, if the undone piece of text is not seen in window,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1821 then point will be moved to the place where the change took place.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1822 Set it to @code{t} and see if you like it better.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1823 @item viper-delete-backwards-in-replace nil
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1824 If not @code{nil}, @key{DEL} key will delete characters while moving the cursor
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1825 backwards. If @code{nil}, the cursor will move backwards without deleting
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1826 anything.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1827 @item viper-replace-overlay-face 'viper-replace-overlay-face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1828 On a graphical display, Viper highlights replacement regions instead of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1829 putting a @samp{$} at the end. This variable controls the so called
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1830 @dfn{face} used to highlight the region.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1831
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1832 By default, @code{viper-replace-overlay-face} underlines the replacement on
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1833 monochrome displays and also lays a stipple over them. On color displays,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1834 replacement regions are highlighted with color.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1835
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1836 If you know something about Emacs faces and don't like how Viper highlights
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1837 replacement regions, you can change @code{viper-replace-overlay-face} by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1838 specifying a new face. (Emacs faces are described in the Emacs Lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1839 reference.) On a color display, the following customization method is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1840 usually most effective:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1841 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1842 (set-face-foreground viper-replace-overlay-face "DarkSlateBlue")
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1843 (set-face-background viper-replace-overlay-face "yellow")
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1844 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1845 For a complete list of colors available to you, evaluate the expression
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1846 @code{(x-defined-colors)}. (Type it in the buffer @code{*scratch*} and then
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1847 hit the @kbd{C-j} key.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1848
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1849 @item viper-replace-overlay-cursor-color "Red"
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1850 @vindex @code{viper-replace-overlay-cursor-color}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1851 Cursor color when it is inside the replacement region.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1852 This has effect only on color displays and only when Emacs runs as an X
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1853 application.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1854 @item viper-insert-state-cursor-color nil
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1855 @vindex @code{viper-insert-state-cursor-color}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1856 If set to a valid color, this will be the cursor color when Viper is in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1857 insert state.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1858 @item viper-replace-region-end-delimiter "$"
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1859 A string used to mark the end of replacement regions. It is used only on
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1860 TTYs or if @code{viper-use-replace-region-delimiters} is non-nil.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1861 @item viper-replace-region-start-delimiter ""
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1862 A string used to mark the beginning of replacement regions. It is used
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1863 only on TTYs or if @code{viper-use-replace-region-delimiters} is non-nil.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1864 @item viper-use-replace-region-delimiters
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1865 If non-nil, Viper will always use @code{viper-replace-region-end-delimiter} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1866 @code{viper-replace-region-start-delimiter} to delimit replacement regions,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1867 even on color displays (where this is unnecessary). By default, this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1868 variable is non-nil only on TTYs or monochrome displays.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1869 @item viper-allow-multiline-replace-regions t
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1870 If non-nil, multi-line text replacement regions, such as those produced by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1871 commands @kbd{c55w}, @kbd{3C}, etc., will stay around until the user exits
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1872 the replacement mode. In this variable is set to @code{nil}, Viper will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1873 emulate the standard Vi behavior, which supports only intra-line
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1874 replacement regions (and multi-line replacement regions are deleted).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1875 @item viper-toggle-key "\C-z"
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1876 Specifies the key used to switch from Emacs to Vi and back.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1877 Must be set in @file{.viper}. This variable can't be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1878 changed interactively after Viper is loaded.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1879
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1880 In Insert state, this key acts as a temporary escape to Vi state, i.e., it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1881 will set Viper up so that the very next command will be executed as if it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1882 were typed in Vi state.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1883 @item viper-ESC-key "\e"
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1884 Specifies the key used to escape from Insert/Replace states to Vi.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1885 Must be set in @file{.viper}. This variable cannot be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1886 changed interactively after Viper is loaded.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1887 @item viper-buffer-search-char nil
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1888 Key used for buffer search. @xref{Viper Specials}, for details.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1889 @item viper-surrounding-word-function 'viper-surrounding-word
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1890 The value of this variable is a function name that is used to determine
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1891 what constitutes a word clicked upon by the mouse. This is used by mouse
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1892 search and insert.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1893 @item viper-search-face 'viper-search-face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1894 Variable that controls how search patterns are highlighted when they are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1895 found.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1896 @item viper-vi-state-hook nil
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1897 List of parameterless functions to be run just after entering the Vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1898 command state.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1899 @item viper-insert-state-hook nil
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1900 Same for Insert state. This hook is also run after entering Replace state.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1901 @item viper-replace-state-hook nil
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1902 List of (parameterless) functions called just after entering Replace state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1903 (and after all @code{viper-insert-state-hook}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1904 @item viper-emacs-state-hook nil
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1905 List of (parameterless) functions called just after switching from Vi state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1906 to Emacs state.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1907 @item viper-load-hook nil
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1908 List of (parameterless) functions called just after loading Viper. This is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1909 the last chance to do customization before Viper is up and running.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1910 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1911 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1912 You can reset some of these constants in Viper with the Ex command @kbd{:set}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1913 (when so indicated in the table). Or you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1914 can include a line like this in your @file{.viper} file:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1915 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1916 (setq viper-case-fold-search t)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1917 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1918 @vindex @code{viper-auto-indent}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1919 @vindex @code{viper-electric-mode}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1920 @vindex @code{viper-case-fold-search}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1921 @vindex @code{viper-re-search}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1922 @vindex @code{viper-shift-width}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1923 @vindex @code{buffer-read-only}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1924 @vindex @code{viper-search-wrap-around}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1925 @vindex @code{viper-search-scroll-threshold}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1926 @vindex @code{viper-search-face}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1927 @vindex @code{viper-tags-file-name}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1928 @vindex @code{viper-re-query-replace}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1929 @vindex @code{viper-want-ctl-h-help}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1930 @vindex @code{viper-vi-style-in-minibuffer}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1931 @vindex @code{viper-no-multiple-ESC}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1932 @vindex @code{viper-always}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1933 @vindex @code{viper-ESC-keyseq-timeout}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1934 @vindex @code{viper-fast-keyseq-timeout}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1935 @vindex @code{viper-ex-style-motion}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1936 @vindex @code{viper-ex-style-editing}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1937 @vindex @code{viper-ESC-moves-cursor-back}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1938 @vindex @code{viper-custom-file-name}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1939 @vindex @code{viper-spell-function}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1940 @vindex @code{ex-cycle-other-window}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1941 @vindex @code{ex-cycle-through-non-files}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1942 @vindex @code{viper-want-emacs-keys-in-insert}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1943 @vindex @code{viper-want-emacs-keys-in-vi}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1944 @vindex @code{viper-keep-point-on-repeat}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1945 @vindex @code{viper-keep-point-on-undo}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1946 @vindex @code{viper-delete-backwards-in-replace}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1947 @vindex @code{viper-replace-overlay-face}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1948 @vindex @code{viper-replace-region-end-symbol}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1949 @vindex @code{viper-replace-region-start-symbol}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1950 @vindex @code{viper-allow-multiline-replace-regions}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1951 @vindex @code{viper-toggle-key}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1952 @vindex @code{viper-ESC-key}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1953 @vindex @code{viper-buffer-search-char}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1954 @vindex @code{viper-surrounding-word-function}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1955 @vindex @code{viper-vi-state-hook}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1956 @vindex @code{viper-insert-state-hook}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1957 @vindex @code{viper-replace-state-hook}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1958 @vindex @code{viper-emacs-state-hook}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1959
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1960 @node Keybindings, Packages that Change Keymaps, Rudimentary Changes,Customization
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1961 @section Keybindings
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1962
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1963 @cindex keybindings
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1964 @cindex keymaps
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1965
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1966 Viper lets you define hot keys, i.e., you can associate keyboard keys
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1967 such as F1, Help, PgDn, etc., with Emacs Lisp functions (that may already
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1968 exist or that you will write). Each key has a "preferred form" in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1969 Emacs. For instance, the Up key's preferred form is [up], the Help key's
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1970 preferred form is [help], and the Undo key has the preferred form [f14].
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1971 You can find out the preferred form of a key by typing @kbd{M-x
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1972 describe-key-briefly} and then typing the key you want to know about.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1973
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1974 Under X Windows, every keyboard key emits its preferred form, so you can
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1975 just type
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1976
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1977 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1978 (global-set-key [f11] 'calendar) ; L1, Stop
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1979 (global-set-key [f14] 'undo) ; L4, Undo
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1980 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1981
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1982 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1983 to bind L1 so it will invoke the Emacs Calendar and to bind L4 so it will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1984 undo changes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1985 However, on a dumb terminal or in an Xterm window, even the standard arrow
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1986 keys may
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1987 not emit the right signals for Emacs to understand. To let Emacs know about
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1988 those keys, you will have to find out which key sequences they emit
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1989 by typing @kbd{C-q} and then the key (you should switch to Emacs state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1990 first). Then you can bind those sequences to their preferred forms using
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1991 @code{function-key-map} as follows:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1992
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1993 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1994 (cond ((string= (getenv "TERM") "xterm")
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1995 (define-key function-key-map "\e[192z" [f11]) ; L1
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1996 (define-key function-key-map "\e[195z" [f14]) ; L4, Undo
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1997 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1998
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1999 The above illustrates how to do this for Xterm. On VT100, you would have to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2000 replace "xterm" with "vt100" and also change the key sequences (the same
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2001 key may emit different sequences on different types of terminals).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2002
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2003 The above keys are global, so they are overwritten by the local maps
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2004 defined by the major modes and by Viper itself. Therefore, if you wish to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2005 change a binding set by a major mode or by Viper, read this.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2006
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2007 Viper users who wish to specify their own key bindings should be concerned
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2008 only with the following three keymaps:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2009 @code{viper-vi-global-user-map} for Vi state commands,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2010 @code{viper-insert-global-user-map} for Insert state commands,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2011 and @code{viper-emacs-global-user-map} for Emacs state commands (note:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2012 customized bindings for Emacs state made to @code{viper-emacs-global-user-map}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2013 are @emph{not} inherited by Insert state).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2014
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2015 For more information on Viper keymaps, see the header of the file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2016 @file{viper.el}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2017 If you wish to change a Viper binding, you can use the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2018 @code{define-key} command, to modify @code{viper-vi-global-user-map},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2019 @code{viper-insert-global-user-map}, and @code{viper-emacs-global-user-map}, as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2020 explained below. Each of these key maps affects the corresponding Viper state.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2021 The keymap @code{viper-vi-global-user-map} also affects Viper's Replace state.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2022
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2023 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2024 If you want to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2025 bind a key, say @kbd{C-v}, to the function that scrolls
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2026 page down and to make @kbd{0} display information on the current buffer,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2027 putting this in @file{.viper} will do the trick in Vi state:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2028 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2029 (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "\C-v" 'scroll-down)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2030 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2031 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2032 To set a key globally,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2033 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2034 (define-key viper-emacs-global-user-map "\C-c m" 'smail)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2035 (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "0" 'viper-info-on-file)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2036 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2037 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2038 Note, however, that this binding may be overwritten by other keymaps, since
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2039 the global keymap has the lowest priority.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2040 To make sure that nothing will override a binding in Emacs state, you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2041 can write this:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2042 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2043 (define-key viper-emacs-global-user-map "\C-c m" 'smail)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2044 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2045 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2046 To customize the binding for @kbd{C-h} in Insert state:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2047 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2048 (define-key viper-insert-global-user-map "\C-h" 'my-del-backwards-function)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2049 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2050 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2051
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2052 Each Emacs command key calls some lisp function. If you have enabled the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2053 Help, (@pxref{Rudimentary Changes}) @kbd{C-h k} will show you the function
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2054 for each specific key; @kbd{C-h b} will show all bindings, and @kbd{C-h m}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2055 will provide information on the major mode in effect. If Help is not
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2056 enabled, you can still get help in Vi state by prefixing the above commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2057 with @kbd{\}, e.g., @kbd{\ C-h k} (or you can use the Help menu in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2058 menu bar, if Emacs runs under X Windows).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2059
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2060 Viper users can also change bindings on a per major mode basis. As with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2061 global bindings, this can be done separately for each of the three main Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2062 states. To this end, Viper provides the function
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2063 @code{viper-modify-major-mode}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2064 @findex @code{viper-modify-major-mode}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2065
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2066 To modify keys in Emacs state for @code{my-favorite-major-mode}, the user
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2067 needs to create a sparse keymap, say, @code{my-fancy-map}, bind whatever
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2068 keys necessary in that keymap, and put
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2069
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2070 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2071 (viper-modify-major-mode 'dired-mode 'emacs-state my-fancy-map)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2072 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2073
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2074 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2075 in @file{~/.viper}. To do the same in Vi and Insert states, you should use
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2076 @code{vi-state} and @code{insert-state}. Changes in Insert state are also
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2077 in effect in Replace state. For instance, suppose that the user wants to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2078 use @kbd{dd} in Vi state under Dired mode to delete files, @kbd{u} to unmark
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2079 files, etc. The following code in @file{~/.viper} will then do the job:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2080
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2081 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2082 (setq my-dired-modifier-map (make-sparse-keymap))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2083 (define-key my-dired-modifier-map "dd" 'dired-flag-file-deletion)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2084 (define-key my-dired-modifier-map "u" 'dired-unmark)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2085 (viper-modify-major-mode 'dired-mode 'vi-state my-dired-modifier-map)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2086 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2087
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2088 A Vi purist may want to modify Emacs state under Dired mode so that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2089 @kbd{k}, @kbd{l}, etc., will move around in directory buffers, as in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2090 Vi. Although this is not recommended, as these keys are bound to useful
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2091 Dired functions, the trick can be accomplished via the following code:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2092
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2093 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2094 (setq my-dired-vi-purist-map (make-sparse-keymap))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2095 (define-key my-dired-vi-purist-map "k" 'viper-previous-line)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2096 (define-key my-dired-vi-purist-map "l" 'viper-forward-char)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2097 (viper-modify-major-mode 'dired-mode 'emacs-state my-dired-vi-purist-map)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2098 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2099
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2100 Yet another way to customize key bindings in a major mode is to edit the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2101 list @code{viper-major-mode-modifier-list} using the customization widget.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2102 @vindex @code{viper-major-mode-modifier-list}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2103 (This variable is in the Viper-misc customization group.)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2104 The elements of this list are triples of the form: (major-mode viper-state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2105 keymap), where the keymap contains bindings that are supposed to be active
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2106 in the given major mode and the given viper-state.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2107
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2108 Effects similar to key binding changes can be achieved by defining Vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2109 keyboard macros using the Ex commands @kbd{:map} and @kbd{:map!}. The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2110 difference is that multi-key Vi macros do not override the keys they are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2111 bound to, unless these keys are typed in quick succession. So, with macros,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2112 one can use the normal keys alongside with the macros. If per-mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2113 modifications are needed, the user can try both ways and see which one is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2114 more convenient.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2115 @findex @kbd{:map}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2116 @xref{Vi Macros}, for details.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2117
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2118 Note: in major modes that come up in @emph{Emacs state} by default, the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2119 aforesaid modifications may not take place immediately (but only after the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2120 buffer switches to some other Viper state and then back to Emacs state). To
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2121 avoid this, one should add @code{viper-change-state-to-emacs} to an
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2122 appropriate hook of that major mode. (Check the function
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2123 @code{viper-set-hooks} in @file{viper.el} for examples.) However, if you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2124 have set @code{viper-always} to @code{t}, chances are that you won't need to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2125 perform the above procedure, because Viper will take care of most useful
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2126 defaults.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2127
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2128
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2129 Finally, Viper has a facility that lets the user define per-buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2130 bindings, i.e., bindings that are in effect in some specific buffers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2131 only. Unlike per-mode bindings described above, per-buffer bindings can be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2132 defined based on considerations other than the major mode. This is done
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2133 via the function @code{viper-add-local-keys}, which lets one specify bindings
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2134 that should be in effect in the current buffer only and for a specific Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2135 state. For instance,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2136 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2137 (viper-add-local-keys 'vi-state '(("ZZ" .@: TeX-command-master)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2138 ("ZQ" .@: viper-save-kill-buffer)))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2139 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2140 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2141 redefines @kbd{ZZ} to invoke @code{TeX-command-master} in @code{vi-state}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2142 and @kbd{ZQ} to save-then-kill the current buffer. These bindings take
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2143 effect only in the buffer where this command is executed. The typical use
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2144 of this function is to execute the above expression from within a function
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2145 that is included in a hook to some major mode. For instance, the above
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2146 expression
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2147 could be called from a function, @code{my-tex-init}, which may be added to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2148 @code{tex-mode-hook} as follows:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2149 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2150 (add-hook 'tex-mode-hook 'my-tex-init)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2151 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2152 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2153 When TeX mode starts, the hook is executed and the above Lisp expression is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2154 evaluated. Then, the bindings for @kbd{ZZ} and @kbd{ZQ} are changed in Vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2155 command mode for all buffers in TeX mode.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2156
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2157 Another useful application is to bind @kbd{ZZ} to @code{send-mail}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2158 in the Mail mode buffers (the specifics of this depend on which mail
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2159 package you are using, @code{rmail}, @code{mh-e}, @code{vm}, etc.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2160 For instance, here is how to do this for @code{mh-e}, the Emacs interface
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2161 to MH:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2162 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2163 (defun mh-add-vi-keys ()
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2164 "Set up ZZ for MH-e and XMH."
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2165 (viper-add-local-keys 'vi-state '(("ZZ" .@: mh-send-letter))))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2166 (add-hook 'mh-letter-mode-hook 'mh-add-vi-keys)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2167 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2168
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2169 You can also use @code{viper-add-local-keys} to set per buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2170 bindings in Insert state and Emacs state by passing as a parameter the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2171 symbols @code{insert-state} and @code{emacs-state}, respectively.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2172 As with global bindings, customized local bindings done to Emacs state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2173 are not inherited by Insert state.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2174
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2175 On rare occasions, local keys may be added by mistake. Usually this is done
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2176 indirectly, by invoking a major mode that adds local keys (e.g.,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2177 @code{shell-mode} redefines @key{RET}). In such a case, exiting the wrong
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2178 major mode won't rid you from unwanted local keys, since these keys are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2179 local to Viper state and the current buffer, not to the major mode.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2180 In such situations, the remedy is to type @kbd{M-x viper-zap-local-keys}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2181
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2182 So much about Viper-specific bindings.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2183 @xref{Customization,,Customization,emacs,The GNU Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2184 Manual}, and the Emacs quick reference card for the general info on key
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2185 bindings in Emacs.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2186
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2187 @vindex @code{function-key-map}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2188 @vindex @code{viper-vi-global-user-map}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2189 @vindex @code{viper-insert-global-user-map}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2190 @vindex @code{viper-emacs-global-user-map}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2191 @findex @code{viper-add-local-keys}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2192 @findex @code{viper-zap-local-keys}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2193
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2194 @node Packages that Change Keymaps,Viper Specials,Keybindings,Customization
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2195 @subsection Packages that Change Keymaps
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2196 @cindex C-c and Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2197 @cindex Viper and C-c
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2198
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2199 Viper is designed to coexist with all major and minor modes of Emacs. This
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2200 means that bindings set by those modes are generally available with Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2201 (unless you explicitly prohibit them by setting
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2202 @code{viper-want-emacs-keys-in-vi} and @code{viper-want-emacs-keys-in-insert} to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2203 @code{nil}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2204 If @code{viper-always} is set to @code{t}, Viper will try to bring each buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2205 in the Viper state that is most appropriate for that buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2206 Usually, this would be the Vi state, but sometimes it could be the Insert
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2207 state or the Emacs state.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2208
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2209 Some major mode bindings will necessarily be overwritten by Viper. Indeed, in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2210 Vi state, most of the 1-character keys are used for Vi-style editing. This
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2211 usually causes no problems because most packages designed for editing files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2212 typically do not bind such keys. Instead, they use key sequences that start
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2213 with @kbd{C-x} and @kbd{C-c}. This is why it was so important for us to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2214 free up @kbd{C-x} and @kbd{C-c}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2215 It is common for language-specific major modes to bind @key{TAB} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2216 @kbd{C-j} (the line feed) keys to various formatting functions. This is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2217 extremely useful, but may require some getting used to for a Vi user. If you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2218 decide that this feature is not for you, you can re-bind these keys as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2219 explained earlier (@pxref{Customization}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2220
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2221 Binding for @key{TAB} is one of the most unusual aspects of Viper for many
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2222 novice users. In Emacs, @key{TAB} is used to format text and programs, and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2223 is extremely useful. For instance, hitting @key{TAB} causes the current
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2224 line to be re-indented in accordance with the context. In programming,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2225 this is very important, since improper automatic indentation would
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2226 immediately alert the programmer to a possible error. For instance, if a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2227 @kbd{)} or a @kbd{"} is missing somewhere above the current
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2228 line, @key{TAB} is likely to mis-indent the line.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2229
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2230 For this reason, Viper doesn't change the standard Emacs binding of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2231 @key{TAB}, thereby sacrificing Vi compatibility
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2232 (except for users at level 1). Instead, in Viper, the key
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2233 @kbd{S-tab} (shift+ tab) is chosen to emulate Vi's @key{TAB}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2234
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2235 We should note that on some non-windowing terminals, Shift doesn't modify
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2236 the @key{TAB} key, so @kbd{S-tab} behaves as if it were @key{TAB}. In such
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2237 a case, you will have to bind @code{viper-insert-tab} to some other
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2238 convenient key.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2239
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2240 Some packages, notably Dired, Gnus, Info, etc., attach special meaning to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2241 common keys like @key{SPC}, @kbd{x}, @kbd{d}, @kbd{v}, and others. This
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2242 means that Vi command state is inappropriate for working with these
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2243 packages. Fortunately, these modes operate on read-only buffers and are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2244 designed not for editing files, but for special-purpose browsing, reading
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2245 news, mail, etc., and Vi commands are meaningless in these situations. For
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2246 this reason, Viper doesn't force Vi state on such major modes---it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2247 brings them in Emacs state. You can switch to Vi state by typing @kbd{C-z}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2248 if, for instance, you want to do Vi-style search in a buffer (although,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2249 usually, incremental search, which is bound to @kbd{C-s}, is sufficient in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2250 these situations). But you should then switch back to Emacs state if you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2251 plan to continue using these major modes productively. You can also switch
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2252 to Vi temporarily, to execute just one command. This is done by typing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2253 @kbd{C-c \}. (In some of these modes, @kbd{/} and @kbd{:} are bound
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2254 Vi-style, unless these keys perform essential duties.)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2255
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2256 If you would like certain major modes to come up in Emacs state rather than
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2257 Vi state (but Viper thinks otherwise), you should put these major modes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2258 on the @code{viper-emacs-state-mode-list} list and delete them from
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2259 @code{viper-vi-state-mode-list}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2260 Likewise, you can force Viper's Insert state on a major mode by putting it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2261 in @code{viper-insert-state-mode-list}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2262 @vindex @code{viper-emacs-state-mode-list}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2263 @vindex @code{viper-insert-state-mode-list}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2264 @vindex @code{viper-vi-state-mode-list}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2265
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2266 It is also possible to impose Vi on some major modes, even though they may
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2267 bind common keys to specialized commands. This might make sense for modes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2268 that bind only a small number of common keys. For instance, Viper subverts
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2269 the Shell mode by changing the bindings for @kbd{C-m} and @kbd{C-d} using
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2270 @code{viper-add-local-keys} described in section on customization
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2271 (@pxref{Customization}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2272
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2273 In some cases, some @emph{minor} modes might override certain essential
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2274 bindings in Vi command state. This is not a big priblem because this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2275 can happen only in the beginning, when the minor mode kicks in. Typing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2276 @code{M-x viper-mode} will correct the situation. Viper knows about
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2277 several such minor modes and takes care of them, so the above trick
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2278 is usually not necessary. If you find that some minor mode, e.g.,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2279 @code{nasty-mode.el} interferes with Viper, putting the following in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2280 @file{.viper} should fix the problem:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2281 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2282 (viper-harness-minor-mode "nasty-mode")
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2283 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2284 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2285 The argument to @code{viper-harness-minor-mode} is the name of the file for the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2286 offending minor mode with the suffixes @file{.el} and @file{.elc} removed.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2287
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2288 It may not be always obvious which minor mode is at fault. The only
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2289 guidance here is to look into the file that defines the minor mode you are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2290 suspecting, say @code{nasty-mode.el}, and see if it has a variable called
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2291 @code{nasty-mode-map}. Then check if there is a statement of the form
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2292 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2293 (define-key nasty-mode-map key function)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2294 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2295 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2296 that binds the misbehaving
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2297 keys. If so, use the above line to harness @code{nasty-mode}. If your
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2298 suspicion is wrong, no harm is done if you harness a minor mode that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2299 doesn't need to be harnessed.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2300
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2301 @vindex @code{viper-want-emacs-keys-in-vi}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2302 @vindex @code{viper-want-emacs-keys-in-insert}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2303 @vindex @code{viper-always}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2304 @findex @code{viper-set-hooks}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2305 @findex @code{viper-mode}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2306 @findex @code{viper-harness-minor-mode}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2307 @findex @code{remove-hook}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2308 @findex @code{add-hook}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2309
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2310 @node Viper Specials,Vi Macros,Packages that Change Keymaps,Customization
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2311 @section Viper Specials
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2312
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2313 Viper extends Vi with a number of useful features. This includes various
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2314 search functions, histories of search strings, Ex commands, insertions, and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2315 Vi's destructive commands. In addition, Viper supports file name completion
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2316 and history, completion of Ex commands and variables, and many other
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2317 features. Some of these features are explained in detail elsewhere in this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2318 document. Other features are explained here.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2319
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2320 @table @code
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2321 @item (viper-buffer-search-enable)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2322 @item viper-buffer-search-char nil
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2323 Enable buffer search. Explicit call to @code{viper-buffer-search-enable}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2324 sets @code{viper-buffer-search-char} to @kbd{g}. Alternatively, the user can
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2325 set @code{viper-buffer-search-char} in @file{.viper} to a key sequence
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2326 to be used for buffer search. There is no need to call
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2327 @code{viper-buffer-search-enable} in that case.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2328 @findex @code{viper-buffer-search-enable}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2329 @vindex @code{viper-buffer-search-char}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2330 @item viper-toggle-search-style
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2331 This function, bound to @kbd{C-c /}, lets one toggle case-sensitive and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2332 case-insensitive search, and also switch between plain vanilla search and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2333 search via regular expressions. Without the prefix argument, the user is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2334 asked which mode to toggle. With prefix argument 1, this toggles
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2335 case-sensitivity. With prefix argument 2, regular expression/vanilla search
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2336 will be toggled.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2337
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2338 However, we found that the most convenient way to toggle
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2339 these options is to bind a Vi macro to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2340 bind @kbd{//} to toggles case sensitivity and to @kbd{///} to toggles
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2341 vanilla search. Thus, quickly hitting @kbd{/} twice will switch Viper from
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2342 case sensitive search to case-insensitive. Repeating this once again will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2343 restore the original state. Likewise, quickly hitting @kbd{/} three times
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2344 will switch you from vanilla-style search to search via regular expressions.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2345 If you hit something other than @kbd{/} after the first @kbd{/} or if the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2346 second @kbd{/} doesn't follow quickly enough, then Viper will issue the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2347 usual prompt @kbd{/} and will wait for input, as usual in Vi.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2348 If you don't like this behavior, you can ``unrecord'' these macros in your
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2349 @file{~/.viper} file. For instance, if you don't like the above feature, put
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2350 this in @file{~/.viper}:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2351 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2352 (viper-set-searchstyle-toggling-macros 'undefine)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2353 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2354 @findex @code{viper-set-searchstyle-toggling-macros}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2355
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2356 @item Vi-isms in Emacs state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2357 Some people find it useful to use the Vi-style search key, `/', to invoke
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2358 search in modes which Viper leaves in emacs-state. These modes are:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2359 @code{dired-mode}, @code{mh-folder-mode}, @code{gnus-group-mode},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2360 @code{gnus-summary-mode}, @code{Info-mode}, and @code{Buffer-menu-mode}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2361 (more may be added in the future). So, in the above modes, Viper binds `/'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2362 so that it will behave Vi-style. Furthermore, in those major modes, Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2363 binds `:' to invoke ex-style commands, like in vi-state. And, as described
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2364 above, `//' and `///' get bound to Vi-style macros that toggle
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2365 case-insensitivity and regexp-search.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2366
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2367 If you don't like these features---which I don't really understand---you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2368 can unbind `/' and `:' in @code{viper-dired-modifier-map} (for Dired) or in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2369 @code{viper-slash-and-colon-map}, for other modes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2370 @vindex @code{viper-slash-and-colon-map}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2371 @vindex @code{viper-dired-modifier-map}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2372
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2373 To unbind the macros `//' and `///' for a major mode where you feel they
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2374 are undesirable, execute @code{viper-set-emacs-state-searchstyle-macros} with a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2375 non-nil argument. This can be done either interactively, by supplying a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2376 prefix argument, or by placing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2377 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2378 (viper-set-emacs-state-searchstyle-macros 'undefine)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2379 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2380 @findex @code{viper-set-emacs-state-searchstyle-macros}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2381 in the hook to the major mode (e.g., @code{dired-mode-hook}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2382 @xref{Vi Macros}, for more information on Vi macros.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2383
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2384 @item viper-heading-start
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2385 @item viper-heading-end
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2386 @cindex headings
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2387 @cindex sections
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2388 @cindex paragraphs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2389 @cindex sentences
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2390 Regular Expressions for @kbd{[[} and @kbd{]]}. Note that Emacs defines
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2391 Regexps for paragraphs and sentences. @xref{Paragraphs,,Paragraphs and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2392 Sentences,emacs,The GNU Emacs Manual}, for details.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2393 @item M-x viper-set-expert-level
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2394 @findex @code{viper-set-expert-level}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2395 Change your user level interactively.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2396 @item viper-smart-suffix-list '("" "tex" "c" "cc" "el" "p")
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2397 @vindex @code{viper-smart-suffix-list}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2398 Viper supports Emacs-style file completion when it prompts the user for a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2399 file name. However, in many cases, the same directory may contain files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2400 with identical prefix but different suffixes, e.g., prog.c, prog.o,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2401 paper.tex, paper.dvi. In such cases, completion will stop at the `.'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2402 If the above variable is a list of strings representing suffixes, Viper will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2403 try these suffixes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2404 in the order listed and will check if the corresponding file exists.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2405
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2406 For instance, if completion stopped at `paper.'@: and the user typed
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2407 @key{RET},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2408 then Viper will check if the files `paper.', `paper.tex', `paper.c', etc., exist.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2409 It will take the first such file. If no file exists, Viper will give a chance
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2410 to complete the file name by typing the appropriate suffix. If `paper.'@: was
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2411 the intended file name, hitting return will accept it.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2412
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2413 To turn this feature off, set the above variable to @code{nil}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2414
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2415 @item viper-insertion-ring-size 14
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2416 @vindex @code{viper-insertion-ring-size}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2417 @cindex Insertion ring
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2418 Viper remembers what was previously inserted in Insert and Replace states.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2419 Several such recent insertions are kept in a special ring of strings of size
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2420 @code{viper-insertion-ring-size}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2421 If you enter Insert or Replace state you can reinsert strings from this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2422 ring by typing @kbd{C-c M-p} or @kbd{C-c M-n}. The former will search the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2423 ring in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2424 the direction of older insertions, and the latter will search in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2425 the direction of newer insertions. Hitting @kbd{C-c M-p} or @kbd{C-c M-n}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2426 in succession
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2427 will undo the previous insertion from the ring and insert the next item on
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2428 the ring. If a larger ring size is needed, change the value of the above
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2429 variable in the @file{~/.viper} file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2430
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2431 Since typing these sequences of keys may be tedious, it is suggested that the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2432 user should bind a function key, such as @kbd{f31}, as follows:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2433 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2434 (define-key viper-insert-global-user-map [f31]
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2435 'viper-insert-prev-from-insertion-ring)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2436 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2437 This binds @kbd{f31} (which is usually @kbd{R11} on a Sun workstation)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2438 to the function that inserts the previous string in the insertion history.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2439 To rotate the history in the opposite
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2440 direction, you can either bind an unused key to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2441 @code{viper-insert-next-from-insertion-ring} or hit any digit (1 to 9) then
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2442 @kbd{f31}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2443
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2444 One should not bind the above functions to @kbd{M-p} or @kbd{M-n}, since
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2445 this will interfere with the Minibuffer histories and, possibly, other
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2446 major modes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2447
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2448 @item viper-command-ring-size 14
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2449 @vindex @code{viper-command-ring-size}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2450 @cindex Destructive command ring
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2451 @cindex Destructive command history
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2452 Viper keeps track of the recent history of destructive
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2453 commands, such as @kbd{dw}, @kbd{i}, etc.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2454 In Vi state,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2455 the most recent command can be re-executed by hitting `@kbd{.}', as in Vi.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2456 However, repeated typing @kbd{C-c M-p} will cause Viper to show the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2457 previous destructive commands in the minibuffer. Subsequent hitting `@kbd{.}'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2458 will execute the command that was displayed last.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2459 The key @kbd{C-c M-n} will cycle through the command history in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2460 opposite direction.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2461 Since typing @kbd{C-c M-p} may be tedious, it is more convenient to bind an
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2462 appropriate function to an unused function key on the keyboard and use that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2463 key. For instance, the following
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2464 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2465 (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map [f31]
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2466 'viper-prev-destructive-command)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2467 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2468 binds the key @kbd{f31} (which is usually @kbd{R11} on a Sun workstation)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2469 to the function that searches the command history in the direction of older
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2470 commands. To search in the opposite
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2471 direction, you can either bind an unused key to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2472 @code{viper-next-destructive-command} or hit any digit (1 to 9) then @kbd{f31}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2473
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2474 One should not bind the above functions to @kbd{M-p} or @kbd{M-n}, since
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2475 this will interfere with the Minibuffer histories and, possibly, other
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2476 major modes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2477
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2478 @item viper-minibuffer-vi-face 'viper-minibuffer-vi-face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2479 @item viper-minibuffer-insert-face 'viper-minibuffer-insert-face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2480 @item viper-minibuffer-emacs-face 'viper-minibuffer-emacs-face
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2481 These faces control the appearance of the minibuffer text in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2482 corresponding Viper states. You can change the appearance of these faces
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2483 through Emacs' customization widget, which is accessible through the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2484 menubar.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2485
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2486 Viper is located in this widget under the @emph{Emulations} customization
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2487 subgroup of the @emph{Editing} group. All Viper faces are grouped together
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2488 in Viper's @emph{Highlighting} customization subgroup.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2489
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2490 Note that only the text you type in is affected by the above faces.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2491 Prompts and Minibuffer messages are not affected.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2492
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2493 Purists who do not like adornments in the minibuffer can always zap them by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2494 putting
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2495 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2496 (copy-face 'default 'viper-minibuffer-vi-face)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2497 (copy-face 'default 'viper-minibuffer-insert-face)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2498 (copy-face 'default 'viper-minibuffer-emacs-face)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2499 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2500 in the @file{~/.viper} file or through the customization widget, as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2501 described above. However, in that case, the user will not have any
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2502 indication of the current Viper state in the minibuffer. (This is important
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2503 if the user accidentally switches to another Viper state by typing @key{ESC} or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2504 @kbd{C-z}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2505 @item M-x viper-go-away
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2506 @findex @code{viper-go-away}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2507 Make Viper disappear from the face of your running Emacs instance. If your
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2508 fingers start aching again, @kbd{M-x viper-mode} might save your day.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2509 @item M-x toggle-viper-mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2510 @findex @code{toggle-viper-mode}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2511 Toggle Viperization of Emacs on and off.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2512 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2513
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2514 @cindex Multifile documents and programs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2515
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2516 Viper provides some support for multi-file documents and programs.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2517 If a document consists of several files we can designate one of them as a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2518 master and put the following at the end of that file:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2519 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2520 ;;; Local Variables:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2521 ;;; eval: (viper-setup-master-buffer "file1" "file2" "file3" "file5" "file5")
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2522 ;;; End:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2523 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2524 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2525 where @code{file1} to @code{file5} are names of files related to the master
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2526 file. Next time, when the master file is visited, the command
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2527 @code{viper-setup-master-buffer} will be evaluated and the above files will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2528 be associated with the master file. Then, the new Ex command
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2529 @kbd{:RelatedFile} (abbr.@: @kbd{:R}) will display files 1 to 5 one after
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2530 another, so you can edit them. If a file is not in any Emacs buffer, it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2531 will be visited. The command @kbd{PreviousRelatedFile} (abbr., @kbd{:P})
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2532 goes through the file list in the opposite direction.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2533 @findex @kbd{:RelatedFile}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2534 @findex @kbd{:PreviousRelatedFile}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2535
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2536 These commands are akin to @kbd{:n} and @kbd{:N}, but they allow the user to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2537 focus on relevant files only.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2538
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2539 Note that only the master file needs to have the aforementioned block of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2540 commands. Also, ";;;" above can be replaced by some other
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2541 markers. Semicolon is good for Lisp programs, since it is considered a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2542 comment designator there. For LaTeX, this could be "%%%", and for C the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2543 above block should be commented out.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2544
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2545 Even though these commands are sometimes useful, they are no substitute for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2546 the powerful @emph{tag table} facility of Emacs. Viper's @kbd{:tag} command
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2547 in a primitive interface to Emacs tags. @xref{Tags,Tags,Tags,emacs,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2548 The Gnu Emacs Manual}, for more information on tags.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2549
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2550 The following two commands are normally bound to a mouse click and are part
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2551 of Viper. They work only if Emacs runs as an application under X
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2552 Windows (or under some other window system for which a port of GNU Emacs 20
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2553 is available). Clicking the mouse when Emacs is invoked in an Xterm window
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2554 (using @code{emacs -nw}) will do no good.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2555
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2556 @table @code
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2557 @cindex mouse
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2558 @cindex mouse-search
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2559 @item viper-mouse-search-key (meta shift 1)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2560 @vindex @code{viper-mouse-insert-key}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2561 This variable controls the @emph{mouse-search} feature of Viper. The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2562 default value
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2563 states that holding Meta and Shift keys while clicking mouse button 1
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2564 should initiate search for a region under the mouse pointer (defined
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2565 below). This command can take a prefix argument, which indicates the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2566 occurrence of the pattern to search for.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2567
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2568 Note: while loading initially, Viper binds this mouse action only if it is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2569 not already bound to something else. If you want to use the mouse-search
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2570 feature and the Meta-Shift-button-1 mouse action is already bound to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2571 something else you can rebind the mouse-search feature by setting
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2572 @code{viper-mouse-search-key} to something else in your @code{~/.viper}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2573 file:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2574 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2575 (setq viper-mouse-search-key '(meta 1))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2576 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2577 This would bind mouse search to the action invoked by pressing the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2578 Meta key and clicking mouse button 1. The allowed values of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2579 @code{viper-mouse-search-key} are lists that contain a mouse-button number
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2580 (1,2, or 3) and any combination of the words `control', `meta', and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2581 `shift'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2582
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2583 If the requested mouse action (e.g., (meta 1)) is already taken for other
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2584 purposes then you have to confirm your intention by placing the following
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2585 command in @code{~/.viper} after setting @code{viper-mouse-search-key}:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2586 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2587 (viper-bind-mouse-search-key 'force)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2588 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2589
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2590 You can also change this setting interactively, through the customization
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2591 widget of Emacs (choose option "Customize.Customize Group" from the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2592 menubar).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2593
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2594 The region that is chosen as a pattern to search for is determined as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2595 follows. If search is invoked via a single click, Viper chooses the region
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2596 that lies between the beginning of the ``word'' under the pointer (``word''
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2597 is understood in Vi sense) and the end of that word. The only difference
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2598 with Vi's words is that in Lisp major modes `-' is considered an
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2599 alphanumeric symbol. This is done for the convenience of working with Lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2600 symbols, which often have an `-' in them. Also, if you click on a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2601 non-alphanumeric character that is not a word separator (in Vi sense) then
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2602 this character will also be considered alphanumeric, provided that it is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2603 adjacent (from either side) to an alphanumeric character. This useful
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2604 feature gives added control over the patterns selected by the mouse click.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2605
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2606 On a double-click, the region is determined by the beginning of the current
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2607 Vi's ``Word'' (i.e., the largest non-separator chunk of text) and the End
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2608 of that ``Word'' (as determined by the @kbd{E} command).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2609
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2610 On a triple-click, the region consists of the entire line where the click
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2611 occurred with all leading and trailing spaces and tabs removed.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2612
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2613 @cindex mouse-insert
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2614 @item viper-mouse-insert-key (meta shift 2)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2615 @vindex @code{viper-mouse-insert-key}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2616 This variable controls the @emph{mouse-insert} feature of Viper.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2617 The above default value states that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2618 holding Meta and Shift keys while clicking mouse button 2
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2619 should insert the region surrounding the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2620 mouse pointer. The rules defining this region are the same as for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2621 mouse-search. This command takes an optional prefix argument, which
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2622 indicates how many such regions to snarf from the buffer and insert. (In
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2623 case of a triple-click, the prefix argument is ignored.)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2624
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2625 Note: while loading initially, Viper binds this mouse action only if it not
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2626 already bound to something else. If you want to use this feature and the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2627 default mouse action is already bound, you can rebind mouse-insert by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2628 placing this command in @code{~/.viper}:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2629 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2630 (setq viper-mouse-insert-key '(meta 2))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2631 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2632 If you want to bind mouse-insert to an action even if this action is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2633 already taked for other purposes in Emacs, then you should add this command
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2634 to @code{~/.viper}, after setting @code{viper-mouse-insert-key}:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2635 @lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2636 (viper-bind-mouse-insert-key 'force)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2637 @end lisp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2638
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2639 This value can also be changed via the Emacs customization widget at the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2640 menubar.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2641
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2642 @item viper-multiclick-timeout
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2643 This variable controls the rate at which double-clicking must occur for the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2644 purpose of mouse search and mouse insert. By default, this is set to
26263
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2645 @code{double-click-time} in Emacs and to
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2646 @code{mouse-track-multi-click-time} milliseconds in XEmacs.
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
2647 @end table
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2648 @kindex @kbd{S-mouse-1}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2649 @kindex @kbd{S-mouse-2}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2650 @kindex @kbd{meta shift button1up}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2651 @kindex @kbd{meta shift button2up}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2652 @vindex @code{viper-multiclick-timeout}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2653 @findex @code{viper-mouse-click-insert-word}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2654 @findex @code{viper-mouse-click-search-word}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2655
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2656 Note: The above functions search and insert in the selected window of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2657 the latest active frame. This means that you can click in another window or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2658 another frame and have search or insertion done in the frame and window you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2659 just left. This lets one use these functions in a multi-frame
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2660 configuration. However, this may require some getting used to. For
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2661 instance, if you are typing in a frame, A, and then move the mouse to frame
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2662 B and click to invoke mouse search, search (or insertion) will be performed
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2663 in frame A. To perform search/insertion in frame B, you will first have to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2664 shift focus there, which doesn't happen until you type a character or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2665 perform some other action in frame B---mouse search doesn't shift focus.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2666
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2667 If you decide that you don't like the above feature and always want
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2668 search/insertion be performed in the frame where the click occurs, don't
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2669 bind (and unbind, if necessary) @code{viper-mouse-catch-frame-switch} from
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2670 the mouse event it is bound to.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2671
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2672 Mouse search is integrated with Vi-style search, so you can
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2673 repeat it with @kbd{n} and @kbd{N}. It should be also noted that, while
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2674 case-sensitivity of search in Viper is controlled by the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2675 @code{viper-case-fold-search}, the case of mouse search is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2676 controlled by the Emacs variable @code{case-fold-search}, which may be set
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2677 differently from @code{viper-case-fold-search}. Therefore, case-sensitivity
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2678 of mouse search may be different from that of the usual Vi-style search.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2679
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2680 Finally, if the way Viper determines the word to be searched for or to be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2681 inserted is not what you want, there is a variable,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2682 @code{viper-surrounding-word-function}, which can be changed to indicate
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2683 another function for snarfing words out of the buffer. The catch is that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2684 you will then have to write such a function and make it known to your
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2685 Emacs. The function @code{viper-surrounding-word} in @file{viper.el} can be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2686 used as a guiding example.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2687
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2688 @node Vi Macros, ,Viper Specials,Customization
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2689 @section Vi Macros
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2690
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2691 @cindex Vi macros
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2692
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2693 Viper supports much enhanced Vi-style macros and also facilitates the use
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2694 of Emacs-style macros. To define a temporary macro, it is generally more
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2695 convenient to use Emacs keyboard macro facility. Emacs keyboard macros are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2696 usually defined anonymously, and the latest macro can be executed by typing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2697 @kbd{C-x e} (or @kbd{*}, if Viper is in Vi state). If you need to use several
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2698 temporary macros, Viper lets you save them to a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2699 register (a lowercase letter); such macros can then be executed by typing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2700 @kbd{@@a} in Vi state (if a macro was previously saved in register
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2701 @kbd{a}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2702 @xref{Macros and Registers}, for details.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2703
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2704 If, however, you need to use a macro regularly, it must be given a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2705 permanent name and saved. Emacs manual explains how to do this, but
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2706 invocation of named Emacs macros is quite different from Vi's. First,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2707 invocation of permanent Emacs macros takes time because of the extra keys.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2708 Second, binding such macros to function keys, for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2709 fast access, hogs valuable real estate on the keyboard.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2710
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2711 Vi-style macros are better in that respect, since Vi lets the user overload
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2712 the meaning of key sequences: keys typed in fast succession are treated
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2713 specially, if this key sequence is bound to a macro.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2714
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2715 Viper provides keyboard macros through the usual Ex commands, @kbd{:map} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2716 @kbd{:map!}. Vi-style macros are much more powerful in Viper than
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2717 they are in the original Vi and in other emulators. This is because Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2718 implements an enhanced vi-style
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2719 interface to the powerful Emacs keyboard macro facility.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2720
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2721 First, any Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2722 command can be executed while defining a macro, not just the Vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2723 commands. In particular, the user can invoke Emacs commands via @kbd{M-x
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2724 command-name} or by pressing various function keys on the keyboard. One
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2725 can even use the mouse, although this is usually not useful and is not
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2726 recommended (and macros defined with the use of the mouse cannot be saved in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2727 command history and in the startup file, for future use).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2728
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2729 Macros defined by mixing Vi and Emacs commands are represented as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2730 vectors. So, don't be confused when you see one (usually through the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2731 history of Ex commands). For instance, if @kbd{gg} is defined by typing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2732 @kbd{l}, the up-arrow key and @kbd{M-x next-line}, its definition will look
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2733 as follows in Emacs:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2734
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2735 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2736 [l up (meta x) n e x t - l i n e return]
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2737 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2738
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2739 Second, Viper macros are defined in a WYSIWYG style. This means that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2740 commands are executed as you type them, so you can see precisely what is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2741 being defined. Third, macros can be bound to arbitrary sequences of keys,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2742 not just to printable keys. For instance, one can define a macro that will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2743 be invoked by hitting @kbd{f3} then @kbd{f2} function keys. (The keys
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2744 @kbd{delete} and @kbd{backspace} are excluded; also, a macro invocation
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2745 sequence can't start with @key{ESC}. Some other keys, such as @kbd{f1} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2746 @kbd{help}, can't be bound to macros under Emacs, since they
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2747 are bound in @code{key-translation-map}, which overrides any other binding
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2748 the user gives to keys. In general, keys that have a binding in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2749 @code{key-translation-map} can't be bound to a macro.)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2750
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2751 Fourth, in Viper, one can define macros that are specific to a given
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2752 buffer, a given major mode, or macros that are defined for all buffers. In
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2753 fact, the same macro name can have several different definitions: one
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2754 global, several definitions for various major modes, and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2755 definitions for various specific buffers. Buffer-specific definitions
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2756 override mode-specific definitions, which, in turn, override global
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2757 definitions.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2758
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2759 As if all that is not enough, Viper (through its interface to Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2760 macros) lets the user define keyboard macros that ask for confirmation or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2761 even prompt the user for input and then continue. To do this, one should
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2762 type @kbd{C-x q} (for confirmation) or @kbd{C-u C-x q} (for prompt).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2763 For details, @pxref{Kbd Macro Query,,Customization,emacs,The GNU Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2764 Manual} @refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2765
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2766 When the user finishes defining a macro (which is done by typing @kbd{C-x)} ---
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2767 a departure from Vi), you will be asked whether you want this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2768 macro to be global, mode-specific, or buffer-specific. You will also be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2769 given a chance to save the macro in your @file{~/.viper} file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2770 This is the easiest way to save a macro and make
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2771 it permanently available. If you work your startup files with bare hands,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2772 here is how Viper saves the above macro so that it will be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2773 available in Viper's Insert state (and Replace state) in buffer @code{my-buf}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2774 only:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2775
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2776 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2777 (viper-record-kbd-macro "gg" 'insert-state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2778 [l up (meta x) n e x t - l i n e return]
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2779 "my-buf")
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2780 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2781
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2782 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2783 To do the same for Vi state and all buffers with the major mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2784 @code{cc-mode}, use:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2785
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2786 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2787 (viper-record-kbd-macro "gg" 'vi-state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2788 [l up (meta x) n e x t - l i n e return]
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2789 'cc-mode)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2790 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2791
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2792 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2793 Both macro names and macro definitions are vectors of symbols that denote
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2794 keys on the keyboard. Some keys, like @kbd{\}, @kbd{ }, or digit-keys must
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2795 be escaped with a backslash. Modified keys are represented as lists. For
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2796 instance, holding Meta and Control and pressing @kbd{f4} is represented as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2797 @kbd{(control meta f4)}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2798 If all members of a vectors are printable characters (or sequences, such as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2799 @kbd{\e}, @kbd{\t}, for @key{ESC} and @key{TAB}), then they can also be represented as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2800 strings:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2801
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2802 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2803 (viper-record-kbd-macro "aa" 'vi-state "aaa\e" "my-buffer")
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2804 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2805
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2806 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2807 Thus, typing @kbd{aa} fast in Vi state will switch Viper to Insert state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2808 (due to the first @kbd{a}), insert @kbd{aa}, and then it will switch back to Vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2809 state. All this will take effect only in the buffer named @code{my-buffer}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2810
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2811 Note that the last argument to @code{viper-record-kbd-macro} must be either a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2812 string (a buffer name), a symbol representing a major mode, or @code{t};
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2813 the latter says that the macro is to be defined for all buffers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2814 (which is how macros are defined in original Vi).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2815
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2816 For convenience, Viper also lets you define Vi-style macros in its Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2817 state. There is no Ex command, like @kbd{:map} and @kbd{:map!} for doing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2818 this, but the user can include such a macro in the @file{~/.viper} file. The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2819 only thing is that the @code{viper-record-kbd-macro} command should specify
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2820 @code{emacs-state} instead of @code{vi-state} or @code{insert-state}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2821
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2822 The user can get rid of a macro either by using the Ex commands @kbd{:unmap}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2823 and @kbd{:unmap!} or by issuing a call to @code{viper-unrecord-kbd-macro}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2824 The latter is more powerful, since it can delete macros even in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2825 @code{emacs-state}. However, @code{viper-unrecord-kbd-macro} is usually
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2826 needed only when the user needs to get rid of the macros that are already
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2827 predefined in Viper.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2828 The syntax is:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2829 @findex @code{viper-unrecord-kbd-macro}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2830 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2831 (viper-unrecord-kbd-macro macro state)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2832 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2833 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2834 The second argument must be @code{vi-state}, @code{insert-state}, or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2835 @code{emacs-state}. The first argument is a name of a macro. To avoid
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2836 mistakes in specifying names of existing macros, type @kbd{M-x
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2837 viper-describe-kbd-macros} and use a name from the list displayed by this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2838 command.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2839
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2840 If an error occurs during macro definition, Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2841 aborts the process, and it must be repeated. This is analogous to Vi,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2842 except that in Vi the user doesn't know there is an error until the macro is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2843 actually run. All that means that in order for a definition to be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2844 successful, the user must do some simple planning of the process in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2845 advance, to avoid errors. For instance, if you want to map @kbd{gg} to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2846 @kbd{llll} in Vi state, you must make sure that there is enough room on the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2847 current line. Since @kbd{l} moves the cursor forward, it may signal an
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2848 error on reaching the end of line, which will abort the definition.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2849
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2850 These precautions are necessary only when defining macros; they will help
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2851 avoid the need to redo the job. When macros are actually run, an error
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2852 during the execution will simply terminate the current execution
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2853 (but the macro will remain mapped).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2854
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2855 A macro name can be a string of characters or a vector of keys.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2856 The latter makes it possible to define macros bound to, say, double-hits
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2857 on a function key, such as @kbd{up} or @kbd{f13}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2858 This is very useful if you run out of function keys on your keyboard; it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2859 makes Viper macro facility a @emph{keyboard doubler}, so to speak.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2860
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2861 Elsewhere (@xref{Keybindings}, for details), we review
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2862 the standard Emacs mechanism for binding function keys to commands.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2863 For instance,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2864
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2865 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2866 (global-set-key [f13] 'repeat-complex-command)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2867 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2868
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2869 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2870 binds the key f13 to the Emacs function that repeats the last minibuffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2871 command. Under Viper, however, you may still use this key for additional
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2872 purposes, if you bind, say, a double-hitting action for that key to some
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2873 other function. Emacs doesn't allow the user to do that, but Viper does
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2874 this through its keyboard macro facility. To do this, type @kbd{:map }
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2875 first. When you are asked to enter a macro name, hit f13 twice, followed by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2876 @key{RET} or @key{SPC}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2877
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2878 Emacs will now start the mapping process by actually executing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2879 Vi and Emacs commands, so that you could see what will happen each time the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2880 macro is executed. Suppose now we wanted to bind the key sequence
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2881 @kbd{f13 f13} to the command @code{eval-last-sexp}. To accomplish this, we
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2882 can type @kbd{M-x eval-last-sexp} followed by @kbd{C-x )}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2883 If you answer positively to Viper's offer to save this macro in @file{~/.viper}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2884 for future uses, the following will be inserted in that file:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2885
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2886 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2887 (viper-record-kbd-macro [f16 f16] 'vi-state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2888 [(meta x) e v a l - l a s t - s e x p]
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2889 'lisp-interaction-mode)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2890 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2891
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2892 To illustrate the above point, Viper provides two canned macros, which, by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2893 default, are bound to @kbd{[f12 \1]} and @kbd{[f12 \2]} (invoked by typing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2894 @kbd{f12} then @kbd{1} and @kbd{2}, respectively). These macros are useful
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2895 shortcuts to Viper's command ring history. The first macro will execute the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2896 second-last destructive command (the last one is executed by @kbd{.}, as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2897 usual). The second macro executes the third-last command.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2898
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2899 If you need to go deeper into the command history, you will have to use
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2900 other commands, as described earlier in this section; or you can bind,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2901 say, @kbd{f12 \3} like this:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2902
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2903 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2904 (viper-record-kbd-macro [f12 \3] 'vi-state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2905 [(meta x) r e p e a t - f r o m - h i s t o r y]
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2906 t)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2907 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2908
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2909
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2910 Note that even though the macro uses the function key @kbd{f12}, the key is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2911 actually free and can still be bound to some Emacs function via
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2912 @code{define-key} or @code{global-set-key}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2913
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2914
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2915 Viper allows the user to define macro names that are prefixes of other macros.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2916 For instance, one can define @kbd{[[} and @kbd{[[[[} to be macros.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2917 If you type the exact sequence of such keys and then pause, Viper will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2918 execute the right macro. However, if you don't pause and, say, type
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2919 @kbd{[[[[text} then the conflict is resolved as follows. If only one of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2920 key sequences, @kbd{[[} or @kbd{[[[[} has a definition applicable to the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2921 current buffer, then, in fact, there is no conflict and the right macro
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2922 will be chosen. If both have applicable definitions, then the first one
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2923 found will be executed. Usually this is the macro with a shorter name. So,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2924 in our case, @kbd{[[[[text} will cause the macro @kbd{[[} to be executed
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2925 twice and then the remaining keys, @kbd{t e x t}, will be processed.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2926
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2927 When defining macros using @kbd{:map} or @kbd{:map!}, the user enters the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2928 actually keys to be used to invoke the macro. For instance, you should hit
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2929 the actual key @kbd{f6} if it is to be part of a macro name; you do
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2930 @emph{not} write `f 6'. When entering keys, Viper displays them as strings or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2931 vectors (e.g., "abc" or [f6 f7 a]). The same holds for unmapping. Hitting
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2932 @key{TAB} while typing a macro name in the @kbd{:unmap} or @kbd{:unmap!} command
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2933 will cause name completion. Completions are displayed as strings or vectors.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2934 However, as before, you don't actually type ``"'', ``['', or ``]'' that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2935 appear in the completions. These are meta-symbols that indicate whether
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2936 the corresponding macro name is a vector or a string.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2937
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2938 One last difference from Vi: Vi-style keyboard macros cannot be defined in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2939 terms of other Vi-style keyboard macros (but named Emacs macros are OK).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2940 More precisely, while defining or executing a macro, the special meaning
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2941 of key sequences (as Vi macros) is ignored.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2942 This is because it is all too easy to create an infinite loop in this way.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2943 Since Viper macros are much more powerful than Vi's it is impossible to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2944 detect such loops. In practice, this is not really a limitation but,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2945 rather, a feature.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2946
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2947 We should also note that Vi macros are disabled in the Minibuffer, which
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2948 helps keep some potential troubles away.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2949
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2950 The rate at which the user must type keys in order for them to be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2951 recognized as a timeout macro is controlled by the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2952 @code{viper-fast-keyseq-timeout}, which defaults to 200 milliseconds.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2953
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2954 For the most part, Viper macros defined in @file{~/.viper} can be shared
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2955 between X and TTY modes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2956 The problem with TTY may be that the function keys there generate sequences
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2957 of events instead of a single event (as under a window system).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2958 Emacs maps some of these sequences back to the logical keys
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2959 (e.g., the sequences generated by the arrow keys are mapped to @kbd{up},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2960 @kbd{left}, etc.). However, not all function keys are mapped in this way.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2961 Macros that are bound to key sequences that contain such unmapped function
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2962 keys have to be redefined for TTY's (and possibly for every type of TTY you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2963 may be using). To do this, start Emacs on an appropriate TTY device and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2964 define the macro using @kbd{:map}, as usual.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2965
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2966 @findex @code{viper-describe-kbd-macros}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2967 Finally, Viper provides a function that conveniently displays all macros
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2968 currently defined. To see all macros along with their definitions, type
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2969 @kbd{M-x viper-describe-kbd-macros}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2970
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2971 @node Commands,,Customization,Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2972 @chapter Commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2973
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2974 This section is a semi-automatically bowdlerized version of the Vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2975 reference created by @* @samp{maart@@cs.vu.nl} and others. It can be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2976 found on the Vi archives. This reference has been adapted for Viper.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2977
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2978 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2979 * Groundwork:: Textual Conventions and Viper basics
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2980 * Text Handling:: Moving, Editing, Undoing.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2981 * Display:: Scrolling.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2982 * File and Buffer Handling:: Editing, Writing and Quitting.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2983 * Mapping:: Mapping Keys, Keyboard Macros
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2984 * Shell Commands:: Accessing Shell Commands, Processing Text
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2985 * Options:: Ex options, the @kbd{:set} commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2986 * Emacs Related Commands:: Meta Keys, Windows
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2987 * Mouse-bound Commands:: Search and insertion of text
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2988 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2989
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2990 @node Groundwork, Text Handling, Commands, Commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2991 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2992 @section Groundwork
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2993
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2994 The VI command set is based on the idea of combining motion commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2995 with other commands. The motion command is used as a text region
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2996 specifier for other commands.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2997 We classify motion commands into @dfn{point commands} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2998 @dfn{line commands}.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2999
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3000 @cindex point commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3001
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3002 The point commands are:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3003
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3004 @quotation
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3005 @kbd{h}, @kbd{l}, @kbd{0}, @kbd{$}, @kbd{w}, @kbd{W}, @kbd{b}, @kbd{B},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3006 @kbd{e}, @kbd{E}, @kbd{(}, @kbd{)}, @kbd{/}, @kbd{?}, @kbd{`}, @kbd{f},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3007 @kbd{F}, @kbd{t}, @kbd{T}, @kbd{%}, @kbd{;}, @kbd{,}, @kbd{^}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3008 @end quotation
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3009
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3010 @cindex line commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3011
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3012 The line commands are:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3013
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3014 @quotation
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3015 @kbd{j}, @kbd{k}, @kbd{+}, @kbd{-}, @kbd{H}, @kbd{M}, @kbd{L}, @kbd{@{},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3016 @kbd{@}}, @kbd{G}, @kbd{'}, @kbd{[[}, @kbd{]]}, @kbd{[]}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3017 @end quotation
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3018 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3019
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3020 Text Deletion Commands (@pxref{Deleting Text}), Change commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3021 (@pxref{Changing Text}), even Shell Commands (@pxref{Shell Commands})
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3022 use these commands to describe a region of text to operate on.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3023
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3024 @cindex r and R region specifiers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3025
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3026 Viper adds two region descriptors, @kbd{r} and @kbd{R}. These describe
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3027 the Emacs regions (@pxref{Basics}), but they are not movement commands.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3028
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3029 The command description uses angle brackets @samp{<>} to indicate
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3030 metasyntactic variables, since the normal conventions of using simple
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3031 text can be confusing with Viper where the commands themselves are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3032 characters. Watch out where @kbd{<} shift commands and @kbd{<count>} are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3033 mentioned together!!!
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3034
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3035 @kindex <move>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3036 @kindex <a-z>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3037 @kindex <address>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3038 @cindex <move>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3039 @cindex <a-z>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3040 @cindex <address>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3041 @cindex movements
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3042
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3043 @samp{<move>} refers to the above movement commands, and @samp{<a-z>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3044 refers to registers or textmarkers from @samp{a} to @samp{z}. Note
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3045 that the @samp{<move>} is described by full move commands, that is to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3046 say they will take counts, and otherwise behave like normal move commands.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3047 @cindex Ex addresses
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3048 @samp{<address>} refers to Ex line addresses, which include
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3049
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3050 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3051 @item .@: <No address>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3052 Current line
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3053 @item .+n .-n
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3054 Add or subtract for current line
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3055 @item number
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3056 Actual line number, use @kbd{.=} to get the line number
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3057 @item '<a-z>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3058 Textmarker
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3059 @item $
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3060 Last line
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3061 @item x,y
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3062 Where x and y are one of the above
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3063 @item %
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3064 @cindex % (Ex address)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3065 For the whole file, same as (1,$).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3066 @item /<pat>/
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3067 @itemx ?<pat>?
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3068 Next or previous line with pattern <pat>.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3069
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3070 Note that the pattern is allowed to contain newline character (inserted as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3071 @kbd{C-qC-j}). Therefore, one can search for patterns that span several
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3072 lines.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3073 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3074
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3075 @cindex % (Current file)
26263
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3076 Note that @samp{%} is used in Ex commands @kbd{:e} and @kbd{:r <shell-cmd>}
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3077 to mean current file. If you want a @samp{%} in your command, it must be
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3078 escaped as @samp{\%}. Note that @kbd{:w} and the regular @kbd{:r <file>}
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3079 command doesn't support the meta symbols @samp{%} and @samp{#}, because
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3080 file history is a better mechanism.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3081 @cindex # (Previous file)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3082 Similarly, @samp{#} expands to the previous file. The previous file is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3083 the first file in @kbd{:args} listing. This defaults to previous window
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3084 in the VI sense if you have one window only.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3085
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3086 @kindex <args>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3087 @kindex <cmd>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3088 @cindex <args>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3089 @cindex <cmd>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3090 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3091 Others like @samp{<args> -- arguments}, @samp{<cmd> -- command} etc.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3092 should be fairly obvious.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3093
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3094 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3095 Common characters referred to include:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3096
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3097 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3098 @item <sp>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3099 Space
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3100 @item <ht>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3101 Tab
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3102 @item <lf>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3103 Linefeed
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3104 @item <esc>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3105 Escape
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3106 @item <cr>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3107 Return, Enter
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3108 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3109 @cindex <cr>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3110 @cindex <esc>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3111 @cindex <lf>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3112 @cindex <ht>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3113 @cindex <sp>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3114
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3115 @cindex words
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3116 @cindex WORDS
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3117 @cindex char
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3118 @cindex CHAR
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3119
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3120 We also use @samp{word} for alphanumeric/non-alphanumeric words, and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3121 @samp{WORD} for whitespace delimited words. @samp{char} refers to any
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3122 ASCII character, @samp{CHAR} to non-whitespace character.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3123 Brackets @samp{[]} indicate optional parameters; @samp{<count>} also
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3124 optional, usually defaulting to 1. Brackets are elided for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3125 @samp{<count>} to eschew obfuscation.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3126
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3127 Viper's idea of Vi's words is slightly different from Vi. First, Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3128 words understand Emacs symbol tables. Therefore, all symbols declared to be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3129 alphanumeric in a symbol table can automatically be made part of the Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3130 word. This is useful when, for instance, editing text containing European,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3131 Cyrillic, Japanese, etc., texts.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3132
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3133 Second, Viper lets you depart from Vi's idea of a word by changing the a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3134 syntax preference via the customization widget (the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3135 @code{viper-syntax-preference}) or by executing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3136 @code{viper-set-syntax-preference} interactively.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3137
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3138 By default, Viper syntax preference is @code{reformed-vi}, which means that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3139 Viper considers only those symbols to be part of a word that are specified
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3140 as word-symbols by the current Emacs syntax table (which may be different
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3141 for different major modes) plus the underscore symbol @kbd{_}, minus the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3142 symbols that are not considered words in Vi (e.g., `,',;, etc.), but may be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3143 considered as word-symbols by various Emacs major modes. Reformed-Vi works
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3144 very close to Vi, and it also recognizes words in other
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3145 alphabets. Therefore, this is the most appropriate mode for editing text
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3146 and is likely to fit all your needs.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3147
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3148 You can also set Viper syntax preference to @code{strict-vi}, which would
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3149 cause Viper to view all non-English letters as non-word-symbols.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3150
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3151 You can also specify @code{emacs} as your preference, which would
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3152 make Viper use exactly the same notion of a word as Emacs does. In
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3153 particular, the underscore may not be part of a word in some major modes.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3154
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3155 Finally, if @code{viper-syntax-preference} is set to @code{extended}, Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3156 words would consist of characters that are classified as alphanumeric
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3157 @emph{or} as parts of symbols. This is convenient for editing programs.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3158
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3159 @code{viper-syntax-preference} is a local variable, so it can have different
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3160 values for different major modes. For instance, in programming modes it can
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3161 have the value @code{extended}. In text modes where words contain special
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3162 characters, such as European (non-English) letters, Cyrillic letters, etc.,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3163 the value can be @code{reformed-vi} or @code{emacs}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3164 If you consider using different syntactic preferences for different major
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3165 modes, you should execute, for example,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3166
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3167 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3168 (viper-set-syntax-preference nil "extended")
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3169 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3170
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3171 in the appropriate major mode hooks.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3172
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3173 @vindex @code{viper-syntax-preference}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3174 @findex @code{viper-set-syntax-preference}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3175 @cindex syntax table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3176
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3177
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3178
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3179 The above discussion concerns only the movement commands. In regular
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3180 expressions, words remain the same as in Emacs. That is, the expressions
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3181 @code{\w}, @code{\>}, @code{\<}, etc., use Emacs' idea of what is a word,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3182 and they don't look into the value of variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3183 @code{viper-syntax-preference}. This is because Viper avoids changing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3184 syntax tables in order to not thwart the various major modes that set these
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3185 tables.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3186
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3187 The usual Emacs convention is used to indicate Control Characters, i.e
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3188 C-h for Control-h. @emph{Do not confuse this to mean the separate
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3189 characters C - h!!!} The @kbd{^} is itself, never used to indicate a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3190 Control character.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3191
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3192 Finally, we note that Viper's Ex-style commands can be made to work on the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3193 current Emacs region. This is done by typing a digit argument before
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3194 @kbd{:}. For instance, typing @kbd{1:} will propmt you with something like
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3195 @emph{:123,135}, assuming that the current region starts at line 123 and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3196 ends at line 135. There is no need to type the line numbers, since Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3197 inserts them automatically in front of the Ex command.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3198 @cindex Ex commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3199
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3200 @node Text Handling, Display, Groundwork, Commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3201 @section Text Handling
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3202
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3203 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3204 * Move Commands:: Moving, Searching
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3205 * Marking:: Textmarkers in Viper and the Emacs Mark.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3206 * Appending Text:: Text insertion, Shifting, Putting
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3207 * Editing in Insert State:: Autoindent, Quoting etc.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3208 * Deleting Text:: Deleting
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3209 * Changing Text:: Changing, Replacement, Joining
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3210 * Search and Replace:: Searches, Query Replace, Pattern Commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3211 * Yanking:: Yanking, Viewing Registers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3212 * Undoing:: Multiple Undo, Backups
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3213 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3214
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3215 @node Move Commands,Marking,,Text Handling
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3216 @subsection Move Commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3217
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3218 @cindex movement commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3219 @cindex searching
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3220 @cindex textmarkers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3221 @cindex markers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3222 @cindex column movement
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3223 @cindex paragraphs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3224 @cindex headings
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3225 @cindex sections
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3226 @cindex sentences
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3227 @cindex matching parens
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3228 @cindex paren matching
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3229
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3230 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3231 @item <count> h C-h
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3232 <count> chars to the left.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3233 @item <count> j <lf> C-n
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3234 <count> lines downward.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3235 @item <count> l <sp>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3236 <count> chars to the right.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3237 @item <count> k C-p
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3238 <count> lines upward.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3239 @item <count> $
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3240 To the end of line <count> from the cursor.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3241 @item <count> ^
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3242 To the first CHAR <count> - 1 lines lower.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3243 @item <count> -
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3244 To the first CHAR <count> lines higher.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3245 @item <count> + <cr>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3246 To the first CHAR <count> lines lower.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3247 @item 0
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3248 To the first char of the line.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3249 @item <count> |
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3250 To column <count>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3251 @item <count> f<char>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3252 <count> <char>s to the right (find).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3253 @item <count> t<char>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3254 Till before <count> <char>s to the right.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3255 @item <count> F<char>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3256 <count> <char>s to the left.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3257 @item <count> T<char>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3258 Till after <count> <char>s to the left.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3259 @item <count> ;
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3260 Repeat latest @kbd{f t F T} <count> times.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3261 @item <count> ,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3262 Repeat latest @kbd{f t F T}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3263 <count> times in opposite direction.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3264 @item <count> w
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3265 <count> words forward.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3266 @item <count> W
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3267 <count> WORDS forward.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3268 @item <count> b
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3269 <count> words backward.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3270 @item <count> B
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3271 <count> WORDS backward.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3272 @item <count> e
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3273 To the end of word <count> forward.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3274 @item <count> E
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3275 To the end of WORD <count> forward.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3276 @item <count> G
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3277 Go to line <count> (default end-of-file).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3278 @item <count> H
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3279 To line <count> from top of the screen (home).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3280 @item <count> L
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3281 To line <count> from bottom of the screen (last).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3282 @item M
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3283 To the middle line of the screen.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3284 @item <count> )
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3285 <count> sentences forward.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3286 @item <count> (
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3287 <count> sentences backward.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3288 @item <count> @}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3289 <count> paragraphs forward.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3290 @item <count> @{
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3291 <count> paragraphs backward.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3292 @item <count> ]]
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3293 To the <count>th heading.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3294 @item <count> [[
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3295 To the <count>th previous heading.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3296 @item <count> []
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3297 To the end of <count>th heading.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3298 @item m<a-z>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3299 Mark the cursor position with a letter.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3300 @item `<a-z>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3301 To the mark.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3302 @item '<a-z>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3303 To the first CHAR of the line with the mark.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3304 @item [<a-z>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3305 Show contents of textmarker.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3306 @item ]<a-z>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3307 Show contents of register.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3308 @item ``
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3309 To the cursor position before the latest absolute
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3310 jump (of which are examples @kbd{/} and @kbd{G}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3311 @item ''
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3312 To the first CHAR of the line on which the cursor
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3313 was placed before the latest absolute jump.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3314 @item <count> /<string>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3315 To the <count>th occurrence of <string>.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3316 @item <count> /<cr>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3317 To the <count>th occurrence of <string> from previous @kbd{/ or ?}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3318 @item <count> ?<string>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3319 To the <count>th previous occurrence of <string>.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3320 @item <count> ?<cr>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3321 To the <count>th previous occurrence of <string> from previous @kbd{?@: or /}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3322 @item n
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3323 Repeat latest @kbd{/} @kbd{?} (next).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3324 @item N
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3325 Repeat latest search in opposite direction.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3326 @item C-c /
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3327 Without a prefix argument, this command toggles
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3328 case-sensitive/case-insensitive search modes and plain vanilla/regular
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3329 expression search. With the prefix argument 1, i.e.,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3330 @kbd{1 C-c /}, this toggles case-sensitivity; with the prefix argument 2,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3331 toggles plain vanilla search and search using
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3332 regular expressions. @xref{Viper Specials}, for alternative ways to invoke
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3333 this function.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3334 @cindex vanilla search
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3335 @cindex case-sensitive search
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3336 @cindex case-insensitive search
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3337 @item %
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3338 Find the next bracket/parenthesis/brace and go to its match.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3339 By default, Viper ignores brackets/parentheses/braces that occur inside
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3340 parentheses. You can change this by setting
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3341 @code{viper-parse-sexp-ignore-comments} to nil in your @file{.viper} file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3342 This option can also be toggled interactively if you quickly hit @kbd{%%%}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3343
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3344 This latter feature is implemented as a vi-style keyboard macro. If you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3345 don't want this macro, put
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3346
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3347 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3348 (viper-set-parsing-style-toggling-macro 'undefine)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3349 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3350 @findex @code{viper-set-parsing-style-toggling-macro}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3351
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3352 in your @file{~/.viper} file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3353
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3354 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3355 @kindex @kbd{%}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3356 @kindex @kbd{C-c /}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3357 @kindex @kbd{N}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3358 @kindex @kbd{n}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3359 @kindex @kbd{?<cr>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3360 @kindex @kbd{/<cr>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3361 @kindex @kbd{?<string>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3362 @kindex @kbd{/<string>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3363 @kindex @kbd{''}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3364 @kindex @kbd{``}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3365 @kindex @kbd{]<a-z>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3366 @kindex @kbd{[<a-z>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3367 @kindex @kbd{'<a-z>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3368 @kindex @kbd{`<a-z>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3369 @kindex @kbd{m<a-z>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3370 @kindex @kbd{[]}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3371 @kindex @kbd{[[}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3372 @kindex @kbd{]]}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3373 @kindex @kbd{@{}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3374 @kindex @kbd{@}}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3375 @kindex @kbd{(}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3376 @kindex @kbd{)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3377 @kindex @kbd{M}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3378 @kindex @kbd{L}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3379 @kindex @kbd{H}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3380 @kindex @kbd{G}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3381 @kindex @kbd{E}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3382 @kindex @kbd{e}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3383 @kindex @kbd{B}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3384 @kindex @kbd{b}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3385 @kindex @kbd{W}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3386 @kindex @kbd{w}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3387 @kindex @kbd{,}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3388 @kindex @kbd{;}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3389 @kindex @kbd{T<char>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3390 @kindex @kbd{F<char>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3391 @kindex @kbd{t<char>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3392 @kindex @kbd{f<char>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3393 @kindex @kbd{|}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3394 @kindex @kbd{0}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3395 @kindex @kbd{<cr>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3396 @kindex @kbd{+}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3397 @kindex @kbd{-}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3398 @kindex @kbd{^}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3399 @kindex @kbd{$}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3400 @kindex @kbd{C-p}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3401 @kindex @kbd{<lf>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3402 @kindex @kbd{<sp>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3403 @kindex @kbd{C-n}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3404 @kindex @kbd{C-h}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3405 @kindex @kbd{h}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3406 @kindex @kbd{j}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3407 @kindex @kbd{k}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3408 @kindex @kbd{l}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3409 @vindex @code{viper-parse-sexp-ignore-comments}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3410
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3411 @node Marking,Appending Text,Move Commands,Text Handling
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3412 @subsection Marking
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3413
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3414 Emacs mark is referred to in the region specifiers @kbd{r} and @kbd{R}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3415 @xref{Emacs Preliminaries}, and @xref{Basics}, for explanation. Also
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3416 see @ref{Mark,,Mark,emacs,The GNU Emacs manual}, for an explanation of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3417 the Emacs mark ring.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3418
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3419 @cindex marking
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3420
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3421 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3422 @item m<a-z>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3423 Mark the current file and position with the specified letter.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3424 @item m .
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3425 Set the Emacs mark (@pxref{Emacs Preliminaries}) at point.
26263
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3426 @item m ^
26490
2b08d829af86 Fix complaints from makeinfo 4.0.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 26263
diff changeset
3427 Set the Emacs mark (@pxref{Emacs Preliminaries}) back to where it was last
26263
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3428 set with the @kbd{m.} command. This is useful when you set the mark with
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3429 @kbd{m.}, but then some other command (such as @kbd{L} or @kbd{G}) changes
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3430 it in a way that you didn't like.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3431 @item m <
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3432 Set the Emacs mark at beginning of buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3433 @item m >
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3434 Set the Emacs mark at end of buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3435 @item m ,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3436 Jump to the Emacs mark.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3437 @item :mark <char>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3438 Mark position with text marker named <char>. This is an Ex command.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3439 @item :k <char>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3440 Same as @kbd{:mark}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3441 @item ``
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3442 Exchange point and mark.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3443 @item ''
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3444 Exchange point and mark and go to the first CHAR on line.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3445 @item '<a-z>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3446 Go to specified Viper mark.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3447 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3448 Go to specified Viper mark and go to the first CHAR on line.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3449 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3450 @kindex @kbd{m<a-z>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3451 @kindex @kbd{m.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3452 @kindex @kbd{m>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3453 @kindex @kbd{m<}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3454 @kindex @kbd{m,}
26263
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3455 @kindex @kbd{m^}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3456 @findex @kbd{:mark}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3457 @findex @kbd{:k}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3458 @kindex @kbd{''}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3459 @kindex @kbd{``}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3460 @kindex @kbd{`<a-z>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3461 @kindex @kbd{'<a-z>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3462
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3463 @node Appending Text, Editing in Insert State, Marking,Text Handling
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3464 @subsection Appending Text
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3465
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3466 @xref{Options}, to see how to change tab and shiftwidth size. See the GNU
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3467 Emacs manual, or try @kbd{C-ha tabs} (If you have turned Emacs help on).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3468 Check out the variable @code{indent-tabs-mode} to put in just spaces.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3469 Also see options for word-wrap.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3470
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3471 @cindex inserting
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3472 @cindex appending
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3473 @cindex paste
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3474 @cindex put
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3475
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3476 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3477 @item <count> a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3478 <count> times after the cursor.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3479 @item <count> A
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3480 <count> times at the end of line.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3481 @item <count> i
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3482 <count> times before the cursor (insert).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3483 @item <count> I
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3484 <count> times before the first CHAR of the line
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3485 @item <count> o
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3486 On a new line below the current (open).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3487 The count is only useful on a slow terminal.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3488 @item <count> O
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3489 On a new line above the current.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3490 The count is only useful on a slow terminal.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3491 @item <count> ><move>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3492 Shift the lines described by <count><move> one
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3493 shiftwidth to the right (layout!).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3494 @item <count> >>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3495 Shift <count> lines one shiftwidth to the right.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3496 @item <count> ["<a-z1-9>]p
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3497 Put the contents of the (default undo) buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3498 <count> times after the cursor. The register will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3499 be automatically down-cased.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3500 @item <count> ["<a-z1-9>]P
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3501 Put the contents of the (default undo) buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3502 <count> times before the cursor. The register will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3503 @item [<a-z>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3504 Show contents of textmarker.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3505 @item ]<a-z>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3506 Show contents of register.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3507 @item <count> .
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3508 Repeat previous command <count> times. For destructive
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3509 commands as well as undo.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3510 @item f1 1 and f1 2
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3511 While @kbd{.} repeats the last destructive command,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3512 these two macros repeat the second-last and the third-last destructive
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3513 commands. @xref{Vi Macros}, for more information on Vi macros.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3514 @item C-c M-p and C-c M-n
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3515 In Vi state,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3516 these commands help peruse the history of Vi's destructive commands.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3517 Successive typing of @kbd{C-c M-p} causes Viper to search the history in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3518 the direction
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3519 of older commands, while hitting @kbd{C-c M-n} does so in reverse
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3520 order. Each command in the history is displayed in the Minibuffer. The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3521 displayed command can
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3522 then be executed by typing `@kbd{.}'.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3523
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3524 Since typing the above sequences of keys may be tedious, the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3525 functions doing the perusing can be bound to unused keyboard keys in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3526 @file{~/.viper} file. @xref{Viper Specials}, for details.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3527 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3528 @kindex @kbd{C-c M-p}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3529 @kindex @kbd{C-c M-n}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3530 @kindex @kbd{.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3531 @kindex @kbd{]<a-z>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3532 @kindex @kbd{[<a-z>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3533 @kindex @kbd{P}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3534 @kindex @kbd{p}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3535 @kindex @kbd{"<a-z1-9>p}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3536 @kindex @kbd{"<a-z1-9>P}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3537 @kindex @kbd{>>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3538 @kindex @kbd{><move>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3539 @kindex @kbd{O}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3540 @kindex @kbd{o}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3541 @kindex @kbd{i}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3542 @kindex @kbd{A}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3543 @kindex @kbd{a}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3544
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3545 @node Editing in Insert State, Deleting Text, Appending Text,Text Handling
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3546 @subsection Editing in Insert State
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3547
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3548 Minibuffer can be edited similarly to Insert state, and you can switch
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3549 between Insert/Replace/Vi states at will.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3550 Some users prefer plain Emacs feel in the Minibuffer. To this end, set
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3551 @var{viper-vi-style-in-minibuffer} to @code{nil}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3552
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3553 @cindex Insert state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3554
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3555 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3556 @item C-v
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3557 Deprive the next char of its special meaning (quoting).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3558 @item C-h
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3559 One char back.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3560 @item C-w
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3561 One word back.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3562 @item C-u
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3563 Back to the begin of the change on the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3564 current line.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3565
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3566 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3567 @kindex @kbd{C-u}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3568 @kindex @kbd{C-w}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3569 @kindex @kbd{C-v}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3570
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3571 @node Deleting Text, Changing Text, Editing in Insert State, Text Handling
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3572 @subsection Deleting Text
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3573
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3574
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3575 There is one difference in text deletion that you should be
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3576 aware of. This difference comes from Emacs and was adopted in Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3577 because we find it very useful. In Vi, if you delete a line, say, and then
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3578 another line, these two deletions are separated and are put back
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3579 separately if you use the @samp{p} command. In Emacs (and Viper), successive
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3580 series of deletions that are @emph{not interrupted} by other commands are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3581 lumped together, so the deleted text gets accumulated and can be put back
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3582 as one chunk. If you want to break a sequence of deletions so that the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3583 newly deleted text could be put back separately from the previously deleted
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3584 text, you should perform a non-deleting action, e.g., move the cursor one
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3585 character in any direction.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3586
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3587 @cindex shifting text
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3588
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3589 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3590 @item <count> x
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3591 Delete <count> chars under and after the cursor.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3592 @item <count> X
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3593 Delete <count> chars before the cursor.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3594 @item <count> d<move>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3595 Delete from point to endpoint of <count><move>.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3596 @item <count> dd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3597 Delete <count> lines.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3598 @item D
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3599 The rest of the line.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3600 @item <count> <<move>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3601 Shift the lines described by <count><move> one
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3602 shiftwidth to the left (layout!).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3603 @item <count> <<
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3604 Shift <count> lines one shiftwidth to the left.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3605 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3606 @kindex @kbd{<<}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3607 @kindex @kbd{<<move>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3608 @kindex @kbd{D}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3609 @kindex @kbd{dd}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3610 @kindex @kbd{d<move>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3611 @kindex @kbd{X}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3612 @kindex @kbd{x}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3613
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3614 @node Changing Text, Search and Replace, Deleting Text,Text Handling
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3615 @subsection Changing Text
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3616
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3617 @cindex joining lines
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3618 @cindex changing case
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3619 @cindex quoting regions
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3620 @cindex substitution
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3621
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3622 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3623 @item <count> r<char>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3624 Replace <count> chars by <char> - no <esc>.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3625 @item <count> R
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3626 Overwrite the rest of the line,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3627 appending change @var{count - 1} times.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3628 @item <count> s
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3629 Substitute <count> chars.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3630 @item <count> S
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3631 Change <count> lines.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3632 @item <count> c<move>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3633 Change from begin to endpoint of <count><move>.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3634 @item <count> cc
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3635 Change <count> lines.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3636 @item <count> C
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3637 The rest of the line and <count> - 1 next lines.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3638 @item <count> =<move>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3639 Reindent the region described by move.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3640 @item <count> ~
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3641 Switch lower and upper cases.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3642 @item <count> J
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3643 Join <count> lines (default 2).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3644 @item :[x,y]s/<pat>/<repl>/<f>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3645 Substitute (on lines x through y) the pattern
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3646 <pat> (default the last pattern) with <repl>. Useful
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3647 flags <f> are @samp{g} for @samp{global} (i.e.@: change every
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3648 non-overlapping occurrence of <pat>) and @samp{c} for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3649 @samp{confirm} (type @samp{y} to confirm a particular
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3650 substitution, else @samp{n} ). Instead of @kbd{/} any
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3651 punctuation CHAR unequal to <space> <tab> and <lf> can be used as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3652 delimiter.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3653
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3654 In Emacs, @samp{\&} stands for the last matched expression, so
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3655 @kbd{s/[ab]+/\&\&/} will double the string matched by @kbd{[ab]}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3656 Viper doesn't treat @samp{&} specially, unlike Vi: use @samp{\&} instead.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3657
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3658 Note: @emph{The newline character (inserted as @kbd{C-qC-j})
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3659 can be used in <repl>}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3660 @item :[x,y]copy [z]
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3661 Copy text between @kbd{x} and @kbd{y} to the position after @kbd{z}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3662 @item :[x,y]t [z]
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3663 Same as @kbd{:copy}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3664 @item :[x,y]move [z]
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3665 Move text between @kbd{x} and @kbd{y} to the position after @kbd{z}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3666 @item &
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3667 Repeat latest Ex substitute command, e.g.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3668 @kbd{:s/wrong/right}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3669 @item C-c /
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3670 Toggle case-sensitive search. With prefix argument, toggle vanilla/regular
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3671 expression search.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3672 @item #c<move>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3673 Change upper-case characters in the region to lower-case.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3674 @item #C<move>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3675 Change lower-case characters in the region to upper-case.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3676 @item #q<move>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3677 Insert specified string at the beginning of each line in the region
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3678 @item C-c M-p and C-c M-n
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3679 In Insert and Replace states, these keys are bound to commands that peruse
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3680 the history of the text
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3681 previously inserted in other insert or replace commands. By repeatedly typing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3682 @kbd{C-c M-p} or @kbd{C-c M-n}, you will cause Viper to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3683 insert these previously used strings one by one.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3684 When a new string is inserted, the previous one is deleted.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3685
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3686 In Vi state, these keys are bound to functions that peruse the history of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3687 destructive Vi commands.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3688 @xref{Viper Specials}, for details.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3689 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3690 @kindex @kbd{C-c M-p}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3691 @kindex @kbd{C-c M-n}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3692 @kindex @kbd{#q<move> }
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3693 @kindex @kbd{#C<move>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3694 @kindex @kbd{#c<move>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3695 @kindex @kbd{&}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3696 @kindex @kbd{\&}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3697 @findex @kbd{:substitute/<pat>/<repl>/<f>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3698 @findex @kbd{:s/<pat>/<repl>/<f>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3699 @findex @kbd{:copy [z]}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3700 @findex @kbd{:t [z]}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3701 @findex @kbd{:move [z]}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3702 @kindex @kbd{J}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3703 @kindex @kbd{~}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3704 @kindex @kbd{=<move>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3705 @kindex @kbd{C}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3706 @kindex @kbd{cc}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3707 @kindex @kbd{c<move>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3708 @kindex @kbd{S}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3709 @kindex @kbd{s}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3710 @kindex @kbd{R}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3711 @kindex @kbd{r<char>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3712
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3713 @node Search and Replace, Yanking, Changing Text,Text Handling
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3714 @subsection Search and Replace
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3715
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3716 @xref{Groundwork}, for Ex address syntax. @xref{Options}, to see how to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3717 get literal (non-regular-expression) search and how to stop search from
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3718 wrapping around.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3719
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3720 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3721 @item <count> /<string>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3722 To the <count>th occurrence of <string>.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3723 @item <count> ?<string>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3724 To the <count>th previous occurrence of <string>.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3725 @item <count> g<move>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3726 Search for the text described by move. (off by default)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3727 @item n
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3728 Repeat latest @kbd{/} @kbd{?} (next).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3729 @item N
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3730 Idem in opposite direction.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3731 @item %
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3732 Find the next bracket and go to its match
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3733 @item :[x,y]g/<string>/<cmd>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3734 @cindex text processing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3735 Search globally [from line x to y] for <string>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3736 and execute the Ex <cmd> on each occurrence.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3737 @item :[x,y]v/<string>/<cmd>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3738 Execute <cmd> on the lines that don't match.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3739 @item #g<move>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3740 Execute the last keyboard macro for each line in the region.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3741 @xref{Macros and Registers}, for more info.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3742 @item Q
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3743 Query Replace.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3744 @item :ta <name>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3745 Search in the tags file where <name> is defined (file, line), and go to it.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3746 @item :[x,y]s/<pat>/<repl>/<f>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3747 Substitute (on lines x through y) the pattern <pat> (default the last
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3748 pattern) with <repl>. Useful
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3749 flags <f> are @samp{g} for @samp{global} (i.e.@: change every
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3750 non-overlapping occurrence of <pat>) and @samp{c} for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3751 @samp{confirm} (type @samp{y} to confirm a particular
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3752 substitution, else @samp{n}). Instead of @kbd{/} any
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3753 punctuation character other than <space> <tab> and <lf> can be used as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3754 delimiter.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3755
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3756 Note: @emph{The newline character (inserted as @kbd{C-qC-j})
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3757 can be used in <repl>}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3758 @item &
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3759 Repeat latest Ex substitute command, e.g.@: @kbd{:s/wrong/right}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3760 @item :global /<pattern>/<ex-command>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3761 @itemx :g /<pattern>/<ex-command>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3762 Execute <ex-command> on all lines that match <pattern>.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3763 @item :vglobal /<pattern>/<ex-command>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3764 @itemx :v /<pattern>/<ex-command>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3765 Execute <ex-command> on all lines that do not match <pattern>.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3766 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3767 @kindex @kbd{&}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3768 @findex @kbd{:substitute/<pat>/<repl>/<f>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3769 @kindex @kbd{Q}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3770 @kindex @kbd{#g<move>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3771 @findex @kbd{:v}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3772 @findex @kbd{:g}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3773 @findex @kbd{:global}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3774 @findex @kbd{:vglobal}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3775 @findex @kbd{:tag <name>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3776 @kindex @kbd{%}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3777 @kindex @kbd{N}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3778 @kindex @kbd{n}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3779 @kindex @kbd{g<move>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3780 @kindex @kbd{?<string>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3781 @kindex @kbd{/<string>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3782
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3783 @node Yanking,Undoing,Search and Replace,Text Handling
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3784 @subsection Yanking
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3785
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3786 @cindex cut and paste
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3787 @cindex paste
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3788
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3789 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3790 @item <count> y<move>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3791 Yank from begin to endpoint of <count><move>.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3792 @item <count> "<a-z>y<move>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3793 Yank from begin to endpoint of <count><move> to register.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3794 @item <count> "<A-Z>y<move>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3795 Yank from begin to endpoint of <count><move> and append
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3796 to register.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3797 @item <count> yy
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3798 <count> lines.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3799 @item <count> Y
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3800 Idem (should be equivalent to @kbd{y$} though).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3801 @item m<a-z>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3802 Mark the cursor position with a letter.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3803 @item [<a-z>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3804 Show contents of textmarker.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3805 @item ]<a-z>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3806 Show contents of register.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3807 @item <count> ["<a-z1-9>]p
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3808 Put the contents of the (default undo) buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3809 <count> times after the cursor. The register will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3810 be automatically down-cased.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3811 @item <count> ["<a-z1-9>]P
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3812 Put the contents of the (default undo) buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3813 <count> times before the cursor. The register will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3814 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3815 @kindex @kbd{P}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3816 @kindex @kbd{p}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3817 @kindex @kbd{"<a-z1-9>p}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3818 @kindex @kbd{"<a-z1-9>P}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3819 @kindex @kbd{]<a-z>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3820 @kindex @kbd{[<a-z>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3821 @kindex @kbd{m<a-z>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3822 @kindex @kbd{Y}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3823 @kindex @kbd{yy}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3824 @kindex @kbd{"<A-Z>y<move>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3825 @kindex @kbd{"<a-z>y<move>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3826 @kindex @kbd{y<move>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3827 @kindex @kbd{yank}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3828 @findex @kbd{:yank}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3830 @node Undoing,, Yanking,Text Handling
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3831 @subsection Undoing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3832
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3833 @cindex undo
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3834 @cindex backup files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3835
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3836 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3837 @item u U
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3838 Undo the latest change.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3839 @item .
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3840 Repeat undo.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3841 @item :q!
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3842 Quit Vi without writing.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3843 @item :e!
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3844 Re-edit a messed-up file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3845 @item :rec
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3846 Recover file from autosave. Viper also creates backup files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3847 that have a @samp{~} appended to them.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3848 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3849 @findex @kbd{:rec}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3850 @findex @kbd{:e!}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3851 @findex @kbd{:q!}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3852 @kindex @kbd{.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3853 @kindex @kbd{U}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3854 @kindex @kbd{u}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3855
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3856 @node Display, File and Buffer Handling, Text Handling, Commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3857 @section Display
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3858
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3859 @cindex scrolling
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3860
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3861 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3862 @item C-g
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3863 At user level 1,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3864 give file name, status, current line number
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3865 and relative position.@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3866 At user levels 2 and higher, abort the current command.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3867 @item C-c g
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3868 Give file name, status, current line number and relative position -- all
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3869 user levels.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3870 @item C-l
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3871 Refresh the screen.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3872 @item <count> C-e
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3873 Expose <count> more lines at bottom, cursor stays put (if possible).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3874 @item <count> C-y
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3875 Expose <count> more lines at top, cursor stays put (if possible).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3876 @item <count> C-d
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3877 Scroll <count> lines downward (default the number of the previous scroll;
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3878 initialization: half a page).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3879 @item <count> C-u
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3880 Scroll <count> lines upward (default the number of the previous scroll;
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3881 initialization: half a page).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3882 @item <count> C-f
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3883 <count> pages forward.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3884 @item <count> C-b
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3885 <count> pages backward (in older versions @kbd{C-b} only works without count).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3886 @item <count> z<cr>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3887 @item zH
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3888 Put line <count> at the top of the window (default the current line).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3889 @item <count> z-
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3890 @item zL
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3891 Put line <count> at the bottom of the window
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3892 (default the current line).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3893 @item <count> z.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3894 @item zM
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3895 Put line <count> in the center of the window
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3896 (default the current line).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3897 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3898 @kindex @kbd{zM}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3899 @kindex @kbd{zL}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3900 @kindex @kbd{zH}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3901 @kindex @kbd{z<cr>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3902 @kindex @kbd{z.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3903 @kindex @kbd{z-}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3904 @kindex @kbd{z<cr>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3905 @kindex @kbd{C-b}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3906 @kindex @kbd{C-f}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3907 @kindex @kbd{C-u}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3908 @kindex @kbd{C-d}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3909 @kindex @kbd{C-y}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3910 @kindex @kbd{C-e}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3911 @kindex @kbd{C-l}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3912 @kindex @kbd{C-g}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3913
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3914
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3915 @node File and Buffer Handling, Mapping, Display,Commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3916 @section File and Buffer Handling
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3917
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3918 @cindex multiple files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3919
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3920 In all file handling commands, space should be typed before entering the file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3921 name. If you need to type a modifier, such as @kbd{>>} or @kbd{!}, don't
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3922 put any space between the command and the modifier.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3923
26263
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3924 Note that many Ex commands, e.g., @kbd{:w}, accept command arguments. The
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3925 effect is that the command would start acting on the current region. For
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3926 instance, if the current region spans the lines 11 through 22, then if you
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3927 type @kbd{1:w} you would see @samp{:11,22w} in the minibuffer.
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
3928
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3929 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3930 @item :q
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3931 Quit buffer except if modified.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3932 @item :q!
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3933 Quit buffer without checking. In Viper, these two commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3934 are identical. Confirmation is required if exiting modified buffers that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3935 visit files.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3936 @item :suspend
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3937 @item :stop
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3938 Suspend Viper
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3939 @item :[x,y] w
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3940 Write the file. Viper makes sure that a final newline is always added to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3941 any file where this newline is missing. This is done by setting Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3942 variable @code{require-final-newline} to @code{t}. If you don't like this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3943 feature, use @code{setq-default} to set @code{require-final-newline} to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3944 @code{nil}. This must be done in @file{.viper} file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3945 @item :[x,y] w <name>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3946 Write to the file <name>.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3947 @item :[x,y] w>> <name>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3948 Append the buffer to the file <name>. There should be no space between
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3949 @kbd{w} and @kbd{>>}. Type space after the @kbd{>>} and see what happens.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3950 @item :w!@: <name>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3951 Overwrite the file <name>. In Viper, @kbd{:w} and @kbd{:w!} are identical.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3952 Confirmation is required for writing to an existing file (if this is not
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3953 the file the buffer is visiting) or to a read-only file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3954 @item :x,y w <name>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3955 Write lines x through y to the file <name>.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3956 @item :wq
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3957 Write the file and kill buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3958 @item :r <file> [<file> ...]
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3959 Read file into a buffer, inserting its contents after the current line.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3960 @item :xit
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3961 Same as @kbd{:wq}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3962 @item :Write
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3963 @itemx :W
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3964 Save all unsaved buffers, asking for confirmation.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3965 @item :WWrite
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3966 @itemx :WW
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3967 Like @kbd{W}, but without asking for confirmation.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3968 @item ZZ
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3969 Save current buffer and kill it. If user level is 1, then save all files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3970 and kill Emacs. Killing Emacs is the wrong way to use it, so you should
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3971 switch to higher user levels as soon as possible.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3972 @item :x [<file>]
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3973 Save and kill buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3974 @item :x!@: [<file>]
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3975 @kbd{:w![<file>]} and @kbd{:q}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3976 @item :pre
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3977 Preserve the file -- autosave buffers.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3978 @item :rec
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3979 Recover file from autosave.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3980 @item :f
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3981 Print file name and lines.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3982 @item :cd [<dir>]
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3983 Set the working directory to <dir> (default home directory).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3984 @item :pwd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3985 Print present working directory.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3986 @item :e [+<cmd>] <files>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3987 Edit files. If no filename is given, edit the file visited by the current
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3988 buffer. If buffer was modified or the file changed on disk, ask for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3989 confirmation. Unlike Vi, Viper allows @kbd{:e} to take multiple arguments.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3990 The first file is edited the same way as in Vi. The rest are visited
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3991 in the usual Emacs way.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3992 @item :e!@: [+<cmd>] <files>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3993 Re-edit file. If no filename, re-edit current file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3994 In Viper, unlike Vi, @kbd{e!} is identical to @kbd{:e}. In both cases, the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3995 user is asked to confirm if there is a danger of discarding changes to a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3996 buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3997 @item :q!
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3998 Quit Vi without writing.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
3999 @item C-^
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4000 Edit the alternate (normally the previous) file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4001 @item :rew
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4002 Obsolete
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4003 @item :args
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4004 List files not shown anywhere with counts for next
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4005 @item :n [count] [+<cmd>] [<files>]
26263
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4006 Edit <count> file, or edit files. The count comes from @kbd{:args}.
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4007 @item :N [count] [+<cmd>] [<files>]
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4008 Like @kbd{:n}, but the meaning of the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4009 @var{ex-cycle-other-window} is reversed.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4010 @item :b
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4011 Switch to another buffer. If @var{ex-cycle-other-window} is @code{t},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4012 switch in another window. Buffer completion is supported.
26263
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4013 The variable @var{viper-read-buffer-function} controls which function is
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4014 actually used to read the buffer name. The default is @code{read-buffer},
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4015 but better alternatives are also available in Emacs (e.g.,
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4016 @code{iswitchb-read-buffer}).
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4017 @vindex @var{viper-read-buffer-function}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4018 @item :B
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4019 Like @kbd{:b}, but the meaning of @var{ex-cycle-other-window} is reversed.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4020 @item :<address>r <name>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4021 Read the file <name> into the buffer after the line <address>.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4022 @item v, V, C-v
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4023 Edit a file in current or another window, or in another frame. File name
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4024 is typed in Minibuffer. File completion and history are supported.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4025 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4026 @kindex @kbd{v}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4027 @kindex @kbd{V}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4028 @findex @kbd{:args}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4029 @findex @kbd{:rew}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4030 @kindex @kbd{C-^}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4031 @findex @kbd{:e!@: [<files>]}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4032 @findex @kbd{:e [<files>]}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4033 @findex @kbd{:edit [<files>]}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4034 @findex @kbd{:edit!@: [<files>]}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4035 @findex @kbd{:q!}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4036 @findex @kbd{:q}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4037 @findex @kbd{:quit}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4038 @findex @kbd{:quit!}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4039 @findex @kbd{:f}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4040 @findex @kbd{:rec}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4041 @findex @kbd{:r}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4042 @findex @kbd{:read}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4043 @findex @kbd{:pre}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4044 @kindex @kbd{ZZ}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4045 @findex @kbd{:wq}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4046 @findex @kbd{:w <file>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4047 @findex @kbd{:w!@: <file>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4048 @findex @kbd{:w >> <file>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4049 @findex @kbd{:write <file>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4050 @findex @kbd{:write!@: <file>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4051 @findex @kbd{:write >> <file>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4052 @findex @kbd{:W}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4053 @findex @kbd{:WW}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4054 @findex @kbd{:Write}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4055 @findex @kbd{:WWrite}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4056 @findex @kbd{:WWrite}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4057 @findex @kbd{:x}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4058 @findex @kbd{:x!}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4059 @findex @kbd{:suspend}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4060 @findex @kbd{:stop}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4061 @findex @kbd{:n [<count> | <file>]}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4062 @findex @kbd{:cd [<dir>]}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4063 @findex @kbd{:pwd}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4064
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4065 @node Mapping, Shell Commands, File and Buffer Handling, Commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4066 @section Mapping
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4067
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4068 @cindex keybindings
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4069 @cindex key mapping
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4070
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4071 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4072 @item :map <string>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4073 Start defining a Vi-style keyboard macro.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4074 For instance, typing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4075 @kbd{:map www} followed by @kbd{:!wc %} and then typing @kbd{C-x )}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4076 will cause @kbd{www} to run wc on
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4077 current file (Vi replaces @samp{%} with the current file name).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4078 @item C-x )
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4079 Finish defining a keyboard macro.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4080 In Viper, this command completes the process of defining all keyboard
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4081 macros, whether they are Emacs-style or Vi-style.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4082 This is a departure from Vi, needed to allow WYSIWYG mapping of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4083 keyboard macros and to permit the use of function keys and arbitrary Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4084 functions in the macros.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4085 @item :unmap <string>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4086 Deprive <string> of its mappings in Vi state.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4087 @item :map!@: <string>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4088 Map a macro for Insert state.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4089 @item :unmap!@: <string>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4090 Deprive <string> of its mapping in Insert state (see @kbd{:unmap}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4091 @item @@<a-z>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4092 In Vi state,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4093 execute the contents of register as a command.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4094 @item @@@@
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4095 In Vi state,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4096 repeat last register command.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4097 @item @@#
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4098 In Vi state,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4099 begin keyboard macro. End with @@<a-z>. This will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4100 put the macro in the proper register. Register will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4101 be automatically down-cased.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4102 @xref{Macros and Registers}, for more info.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4103 @item @@!<a-z>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4104 In Vi state,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4105 yank anonymous macro to register
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4106 @item *
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4107 In Vi state,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4108 execute anonymous macro (defined by C-x( and C-x )).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4109 @item C-x e
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4110 Like @kbd{*}, but works in all Viper states.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4111 @item #g<move>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4112 Execute the last keyboard macro for each line in the region.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4113 @xref{Macros and Registers}, for more info.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4114 @item [<a-z>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4115 Show contents of textmarker.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4116 @item ]<a-z>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4117 Show contents of register.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4118 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4119 @kindex @kbd{]<a-z>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4120 @kindex @kbd{[<a-z>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4121 @kindex @kbd{#g<move>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4122 @kindex @kbd{*}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4123 @kindex @kbd{@@!<a-z>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4124 @kindex @kbd{@@#}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4125 @kindex @kbd{@@@@}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4126 @kindex @kbd{@@<a-z>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4127 @findex @kbd{:unmap <char>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4128 @findex @kbd{:map <char> <seq>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4129 @findex @kbd{:unmap!@: <char>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4130 @findex @kbd{:map!@: <char> <seq>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4131
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4132 @node Shell Commands, Options, Mapping, Commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4133 @section Shell Commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4134
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4135 @cindex % (Current file)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4136
26263
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4137 The symbol @samp{%} is used in Ex shell commands to mean current file. If
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4138 you want a @samp{%} in your command, it must be escaped as @samp{\%}.
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4139 @cindex @samp{%} (Ex address)
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4140 However if @samp{%} is the first character, it stands as the address for
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4141 the whole file.
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4142 @cindex @samp{#} (Previous file)
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4143 Similarly, @samp{#} expands to the previous file. The previous file is the
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4144 first file in @kbd{:args} listing. This defaults to the previous file in
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4145 the VI sense if you have one window.@refill
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4146
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4147 Symbols @samp{%} and @samp{#} are also used in the Ex commands @kbd{:e} and
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4148 @kbd{:r <shell-cmd>}. The commands @kbd{:w} and the regular @kbd{:r
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4149 <file>} command don't support these meta symbols, because file history is a
4f315ca65976 *** empty log message ***
Michael Kifer <kifer@cs.stonybrook.edu>
parents: 25829
diff changeset
4150 better mechanism.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4151
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4152 @cindex shell commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4153
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4154 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4155 @item :sh
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4156 Execute a subshell in another window
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4157 @item :[x,y]!<cmd>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4158 Execute a shell <cmd> [on lines x through y;
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4159 % is replace by current file, \% is changed to %
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4160 @item :[x,y]!!@: [<args>]
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4161 Repeat last shell command [and append <args>].
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4162 @item :!<cmd>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4163 Just execute command and display result in a buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4164 @item :!!@: <args>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4165 Repeat last shell command and append <args>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4166 @item <count> !<move><cmd>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4167 The shell executes <cmd>, with standard
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4168 input the lines described by <count><move>,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4169 next the standard output replaces those lines
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4170 (think of @samp{cb}, @samp{sort}, @samp{nroff}, etc.).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4171 @item <count> !!<cmd>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4172 Give <count> lines as standard input to the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4173 shell <cmd>, next let the standard output
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4174 replace those lines.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4175 @item :[x,y] w !<cmd>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4176 Let lines x to y be standard input for <cmd>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4177 (notice the <sp> between @kbd{w} and @kbd{!}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4178 @item :<address>r !<cmd>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4179 Put the output of <cmd> after the line <address> (default current).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4180 @item :<address>r <name>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4181 Read the file <name> into the buffer after the line <address> (default
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4182 current).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4183 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4184 @findex @kbd{:<address>r <name>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4185 @findex @kbd{:<address>r !<cmd>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4186 @findex @kbd{!<cmd>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4187 @findex @kbd{!!<cmd>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4188 @findex @kbd{!<move><cmd>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4189 @findex @kbd{:w !<cmd>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4190 @findex @kbd{:x,y w !<cmd>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4191 @findex @kbd{:!!@: <args>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4192 @findex @kbd{:!<cmd>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4193 @findex @kbd{:sh}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4194
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4195 @node Options,Emacs Related Commands,Shell Commands,Commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4196 @section Options
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4197
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4198 @cindex Vi options
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4199
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4200 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4201 @item autoindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4202 @itemx ai
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4203 @cindex autoindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4204 autoindent -- In append mode after a <cr> the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4205 cursor will move directly below the first
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4206 character on the previous line.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4207 This setting affects the current buffer only.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4208 @item autoindent-global
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4209 @itemx ai-global
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4210 Same as `autoindent', but affects all buffers.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4211 @item noautoindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4212 @itemx noai
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4213 Cancel autoindent.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4214 @item noautoindent-global
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4215 @itemx noai-g
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4216 Cancel autoindent-global.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4217 @item ignorecase
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4218 @itemx ic
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4219 @cindex case and searching
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4220 ignorecase -- No distinction between upper and lower cases when searching.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4221 @item noignorecase
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4222 @itemx noic
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4223 Cancel ignorecase.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4224 @item magic
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4225 @itemx ma
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4226 @cindex literal searching
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4227 Regular expressions used in searches; nomagic means no regexps.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4228 @item nomagic
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4229 @item noma
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4230 Cancel magic.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4231 @item readonly
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4232 @itemx ro
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4233 @cindex readonly files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4234 readonly -- The file is not to be changed.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4235 If the user attempts to write to this file, confirmation will be requested.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4236 @item noreadonly
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4237 @itemx noro
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4238 Cancel readonly.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4239 @item shell=<string>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4240 @itemx sh=<string>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4241 @cindex shell
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4242 shell -- The program to be used for shell escapes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4243 (default @samp{$SHELL} (default @file{/bin/sh})).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4244 @item shiftwidth=<count>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4245 @itemx sw=<count>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4246 @cindex layout
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4247 @cindex shifting text
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4248 shiftwidth -- Gives the shiftwidth (default 8 positions).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4249 @item showmatch
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4250 @itemx sm
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4251 @cindex paren matching
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4252 @cindex matching parens
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4253 showmatch -- Whenever you append a @kbd{)}, Vi shows
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4254 its match if it's on the same page; also with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4255 @kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}}. If there's no match, Vi will beep.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4256 @item noshowmatch
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4257 @itemx nosm
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4258 Cancel showmatch.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4259 @item tabstop=<count>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4260 @itemx ts=<count>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4261 @cindex changing tab width
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4262 @cindex tabbing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4263 tabstop -- The length of a <ht>; warning: this is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4264 only IN the editor, outside of it <ht>s have
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4265 their normal length (default 8 positions).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4266 This setting affects the current buffer only.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4267 @item tabstop-global
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4268 @itemx ts-g
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4269 Same as `tabstop', but affects all buffers.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4270 @item wrapmargin=<count>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4271 @itemx wm=<count>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4272 @cindex auto fill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4273 @cindex word wrap
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4274 wrapmargin -- In append mode Vi automatically
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4275 puts a <lf> whenever there is a <sp> or <ht>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4276 within <wm> columns from the right margin.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4277 @item wrapscan
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4278 @itemx ws
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4279 @cindex searching
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4280 wrapscan -- When searching, the end is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4281 considered @samp{stuck} to the begin of the file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4282 @item nowrapscan
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4283 @itemx nows
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4284 Cancel wrapscan.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4285 @item :set <option>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4286 Turn <option> on.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4287 @item :set no<option>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4288 Turn <option> off.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4289 @item :set <option>=<value>
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4290 Set <option> to <value>.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4291 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4292 @findex @kbd{:set <option>=<value>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4293 @findex @kbd{:set no<option>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4294 @findex @kbd{:set <option>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4295 @findex @kbd{:set ws}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4296 @findex @kbd{:set wrapscan}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4297 @findex @kbd{:set wm=<count>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4298 @findex @kbd{:set wrapmargin=<count>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4299 @findex @kbd{:set ts=<count>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4300 @findex @kbd{:set tabstop=<count>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4301 @findex @kbd{:set tab-stop-local=<count>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4302 @findex @kbd{:set sm}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4303 @findex @kbd{:set showmatch}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4304 @findex @kbd{:set sw=<count>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4305 @findex @kbd{:set shiftwidth=<count>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4306 @findex @kbd{:set sh=<string>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4307 @findex @kbd{:set shell=<string>}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4308 @findex @kbd{:set ro}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4309 @findex @kbd{:set readonly}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4310 @findex @kbd{:set magic}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4311 @findex @kbd{:set ic}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4312 @findex @kbd{:set ignorecase}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4313 @findex @kbd{:set ai}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4314 @findex @kbd{:set autoindent}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4315
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4316 @node Emacs Related Commands,,Options,Commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4317 @section Emacs Related Commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4318
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4319 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4320 @item C-\
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4321 Begin Meta command in Vi or Insert states. Most often used as C-\ x (M-x).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4322
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4323 Note: Emacs binds @kbd{C-\} to a function that offers to change the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4324 keyboard input method in the multilingual environment. Viper overrides this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4325 binding. However, it is still possible to switch the input method by typing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4326 @kbd{\ C-\} in the Vi command state and @kbd{C-z \ C-\} in the Insert state.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4327 Or you can use the MULE menu on the menubar.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4328 @item C-z
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4329 In Insert and Replace states, prepare Viper to accept the next command and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4330 execute it as if Viper was in Vi state. Then return to Insert state.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4331
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4332 In Vi state, switch to Emacs state; in Emacs state, switch to Vi state.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4333 @item C-c \
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4334 Switches to Vi state for the duration of a single command. Then goes back
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4335 to the original Viper state. Works from Vi, Insert, Replace, and Emacs states.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4336 @item C-x0
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4337 Close Window
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4338 @item C-x1
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4339 Close Other Windows
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4340 @item C-x2
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4341 Split Window
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4342 @item C-xo
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4343 Move among windows
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4344 @item C-xC-f
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4345 Emacs find-file, useful in Insert state
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4346 @item C-y
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4347 Put back the last killed text. Similar to Vi's @kbd{p}, but also works in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4348 Insert and Replace state. This command doesn't work in Vi command state,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4349 since this binding is taken for something else.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4350 @item M-y
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4351 Undoes the last @kbd{C-y} and puts another kill from the kill ring.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4352 Using this command, you can try may different kills until you find the one
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4353 you need.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4354 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4355 @kindex @kbd{M-y}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4356 @kindex @kbd{C-y}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4357 @kindex @kbd{C-xC-f}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4358 @kindex @kbd{C-xo}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4359 @kindex @kbd{C-x2}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4360 @kindex @kbd{C-x1}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4361 @kindex @kbd{C-x0}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4362 @kindex @kbd{C-z}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4363 @kindex @kbd{C-\}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4364 @kindex @kbd{C-c\}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4365
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4366 @node Mouse-bound Commands,,,Commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4367 @section Mouse-bound Commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4368
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4369 The following two mouse actions are normally bound to to special search and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4370 insert commands in of Viper:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4371
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4372 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4373 @item S-mouse-1
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4374 Holding Shift and clicking mouse button 1 will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4375 initiate search for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4376 a region under the mouse pointer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4377 This command can take a prefix argument. Note: Viper sets this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4378 binding only if this mouse action is not
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4379 already bound to something else.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4380 @xref{Viper Specials}, for more information.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4381
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4382 @item S-mouse-2
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4383 Holding Shift and clicking button 2 of the mouse will
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4384 insert a region surrounding the mouse pointer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4385 This command can also take a prefix argument.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4386 Note: Viper sets this binding only if this mouse action is not
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4387 already bound to something else.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4388 @xref{Viper Specials}, for more details.@refill
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4389 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4390 @kindex @kbd{S-mouse-1}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4391 @kindex @kbd{S-mouse-2}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4392 @kindex @kbd{meta button1up}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4393 @kindex @kbd{meta button2up}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4394
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4395 @node Acknowledgments,,,Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4396 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4397 @unnumbered Acknowledgments
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4398
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4399 Viper, formerly known as VIP-19, was written by Michael Kifer. Viper is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4400 based on the original VIP package by Masahiko Sato and on its enhancement,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4401 VIP 4.4, by Aamod Sane. This manual is an adaptation of the manual for VIP
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4402 4.4, which, in turn, was based on Sato's manual for VIP 3.5.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4403
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4404 Many contributors on the net pointed out bugs and suggested a number of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4405 useful features. Here is a (hopefully) complete list of contributors:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4406
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4407 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4408 ahg@@panix.com (Al Gelders),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4409 amade@@diagram.fr (Paul-Bernard Amade),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4410 ascott@@fws214.intel.com (Andy Scott),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4411 cook@@biostat.wisc.edu (Tom Cook),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4412 csdayton@@midway.uchicago.edu (Soren Dayton),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4413 dave@@hellgate.utah.edu,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4414 dominik@@strw.LeidenUniv.nl (Carsten Dominik),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4415 dwallach@@cs.princeton.edu (Dan Wallach),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4416 dwight@@toolucky.llnl.gov (Dwight Shih),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4417 edmonds@@edmonds.home.cs.ubc.ca (Brian Edmonds),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4418 gviswana@@cs.wisc.edu (Guhan Viswanathan),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4419 gvr@@halcyon.com (George V.@: Reilly),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4420 hatazaki@@bach.convex.com (Takao Hatazaki),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4421 hpz@@ibmhpz.aug.ipp-garching.mpg.de (Hans-Peter Zehrfeld),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4422 jackr@@dblues.engr.sgi.com (Jack Repenning),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4423 jamesm@@bga.com (D.J.@: Miller II),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4424 jjm@@hplb.hpl.hp.com (Jean-Jacques Moreau),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4425 jl@@cse.ogi.edu (John Launchbury),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4426 jobrien@@hchp.org (John O'Brien),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4427 johnw@@borland.com (John Wiegley),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4428 kanze@@gabi-soft.fr (James Kanze),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4429 kin@@isi.com (Kin Cho),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4430 kwzh@@gnu.org (Karl Heuer),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4431 lindstro@@biostat.wisc.edu (Mary Lindstrom),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4432 Mark.Bordas@@East.Sun.COM (Mark Bordas),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4433 meyering@@comco.com (Jim Meyering),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4434 mrb@@Eng.Sun.COM (Martin Buchholz),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4435 mveiga@@dit.upm.es (Marcelino Veiga Tuimil),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4436 paulk@@summit.esg.apertus.com (Paul Keusemann),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4437 pfister@@cs.sunysb.edu (Hanspeter Pfister),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4438 phil_brooks@@MENTORG.COM (Phil Brooks),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4439 pogrell@@informatik.hu-berlin.de (Lutz Pogrell),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4440 pradyut@@cs.uchicago.edu (Pradyut Shah),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4441 roderick@@argon.org (Roderick Schertler),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4442 rxga@@ulysses.att.com,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4443 sawdey@@lcse.umn.edu (Aaron Sawdey),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4444 simonb@@prl.philips.co.uk (Simon Blanchard),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4445 stephen@@farrell.org (Stephen Farrell),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4446 sudish@@MindSpring.COM (Sudish Joseph),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4447 schwab@@issan.informatik.uni-dortmund.de (Andreas Schwab)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4448 terra@@diku.dk (Morten Welinder),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4449 thanh@@informatics.muni.cz (Han The Thanh),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4450 toma@@convex.convex.com,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4451 vrenjak@@sun1.racal.com (Milan Vrenjak),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4452 whicken@@dragon.parasoft.com (Wendell Hicken),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4453 zapman@@cc.gatech.edu (Jason Zapman II),
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4454 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4455
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4456
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4457 @node Key Index,Function Index,,Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4458 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4459 @unnumbered Key Index
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4460
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4461 @printindex ky
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4462
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4463 @node Function Index,Variable Index,Key Index,Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4464 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4465 @unnumbered Function Index
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4466
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4467 @printindex fn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4468
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4469 @node Variable Index,Package Index,Function Index,Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4470 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4471 @unnumbered Variable Index
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4472
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4473 @printindex vr
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4474
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4475 @node Package Index,Concept Index,Variable Index,Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4476 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4477 @unnumbered Package Index
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4478
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4479 @printindex pg
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4480
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4481 @node Concept Index,,Package Index,Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4482 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4483 @unnumbered Concept Index
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4484
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4485 @printindex cp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4486
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4487 @contents
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4488 @bye